blob: dcc7b2528904ab48a8f318dd5407895e1a5b53ea [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattnerdd1a86d2004-05-04 15:19:33 +000015// %Y = add int %X, 1
16// %Z = add int %Y, 1
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattnerdd1a86d2004-05-04 15:19:33 +000018// %Z = add int %X, 2
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner216c7b82003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000027// 3. SetCC instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All SetCC instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattnerb4cfa7f2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000042#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
43#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000045#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000046#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000048#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000049#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +000050#include "llvm/ADT/DepthFirstIterator.h"
Reid Spencer7c16caa2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000051#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000052#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +000053#include <algorithm>
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000054using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000055using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +000056
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000057namespace {
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000058 Statistic<> NumCombined ("instcombine", "Number of insts combined");
59 Statistic<> NumConstProp("instcombine", "Number of constant folds");
60 Statistic<> NumDeadInst ("instcombine", "Number of dead inst eliminated");
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000061 Statistic<> NumSunkInst ("instcombine", "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000062
Chris Lattnerc8e66542002-04-27 06:56:12 +000063 class InstCombiner : public FunctionPass,
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000064 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
65 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
66 std::vector<Instruction*> WorkList;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000067 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000068
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +000069 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
70 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
71 /// now.
72 ///
73 void AddUsersToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +000074 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000075 UI != UE; ++UI)
76 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
77 }
78
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +000079 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
80 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
81 ///
82 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
83 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
84 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
85 WorkList.push_back(Op);
86 }
87
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000088 // removeFromWorkList - remove all instances of I from the worklist.
89 void removeFromWorkList(Instruction *I);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000090 public:
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +000091 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000092
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +000093 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000094 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Chris Lattner820d9712002-10-21 20:00:28 +000095 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +000096 }
97
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000098 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
99
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000100 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
101 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
102 // Return Value:
103 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000104 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000105 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000106 //
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000107 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
108 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
109 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
110 Instruction *visitDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
111 Instruction *visitRem(BinaryOperator &I);
112 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
113 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
114 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000115 Instruction *visitSetCondInst(SetCondInst &I);
116 Instruction *visitSetCondInstWithCastAndCast(SetCondInst &SCI);
117
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000118 Instruction *FoldGEPSetCC(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
119 Instruction::BinaryOps Cond, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnere8d6c602003-03-10 19:16:08 +0000120 Instruction *visitShiftInst(ShiftInst &I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000121 Instruction *visitCastInst(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000122 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
123 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000124 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000125 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
126 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000127 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
128 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000129 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000130 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000131 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000132 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000133 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000134 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000135
136 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000137 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000138
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000139 private:
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000140 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000141 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
142
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000143 public:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000144 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
145 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
146 //
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000147 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattner65217ff2002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000148 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
149 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000150 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
151 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
152 WorkList.push_back(New); // Add to worklist
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000153 return New;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000154 }
155
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000156 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
157 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
158 /// cast.
159 Value *InsertCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
160 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000161
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000162 Instruction *C = new CastInst(V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
163 WorkList.push_back(C);
164 return C;
165 }
166
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000167 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
168 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
169 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
170 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
171 // modified.
172 //
173 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000174 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000175 if (&I != V) {
176 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
177 return &I;
178 } else {
179 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
180 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000181 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000182 return &I;
183 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000184 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000185
186 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
187 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
188 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
189 // this function.
190 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
191 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
192 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
193 removeFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000194 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000195 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
196 }
197
198
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000199 private:
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000200 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
201 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
202 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
203 ///
204 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
205 Instruction *InsertBefore);
206
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000207 // SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000208 // operators.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000209 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000210
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000211
212 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
213 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
214 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
215 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
216
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000217 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
218 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
219 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
220 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
221
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000222 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantIntegral *OpRHS,
223 ConstantIntegral *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000224
225 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
226 bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000227 };
Chris Lattnerb28b6802002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000228
Chris Lattnerc8b70922002-07-26 21:12:46 +0000229 RegisterOpt<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000230}
231
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000232// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000233// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000234static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
235 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
236 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000237 return 3;
238 return 4;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000239 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000240 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
241 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000242}
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000243
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000244// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
245// it.
246static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000247 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000248}
249
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000250// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
251// though a va_arg area...
252static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Chris Lattner97bfcea2004-06-17 18:16:02 +0000253 switch (Ty->getTypeID()) {
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000254 case Type::SByteTyID:
255 case Type::ShortTyID: return Type::IntTy;
256 case Type::UByteTyID:
257 case Type::UShortTyID: return Type::UIntTy;
258 case Type::FloatTyID: return Type::DoubleTy;
259 default: return Ty;
260 }
261}
262
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000263// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
264// operators:
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000265//
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000266// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
267// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
268// binary operators.
269//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000270// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
271// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000272//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000273bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000274 bool Changed = false;
275 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
276 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000277
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000278 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
279 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000280 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
281 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
282 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000283 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
284 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
285 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000286 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
287 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
288 return true;
289 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
290 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
291 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
292 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
293 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
294
295 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000296 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000297 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
298 Op1->getOperand(0),
299 Op1->getName(), &I);
300 WorkList.push_back(New);
301 I.setOperand(0, New);
302 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
303 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000304 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000305 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000306 return Changed;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000307}
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000308
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000309// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
310// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000311//
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000312static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
313 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000314 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000315
Chris Lattner9ad0d552004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000316 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
317 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
318 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000319 return 0;
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000320}
321
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000322static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
323 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000324 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000325
326 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Chris Lattnerdd65d862003-04-30 22:34:06 +0000327 if (ConstantIntegral *C = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(V))
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +0000328 return ConstantExpr::getNot(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000329 return 0;
330}
331
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000332// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
333// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000334// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
335// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000336//
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000337static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000338 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000339 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000340 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000341 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000342 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000343 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000344 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000345 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
346 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
347 CST = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getShl(One, CST));
348 return I->getOperand(0);
349 }
350 }
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000351 return 0;
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000352}
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000353
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000354/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
355/// expression, return it.
356static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
357 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
358 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
359 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
360 return cast<User>(V);
361 return false;
362}
363
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000364// Log2 - Calculate the log base 2 for the specified value if it is exactly a
365// power of 2.
366static unsigned Log2(uint64_t Val) {
367 assert(Val > 1 && "Values 0 and 1 should be handled elsewhere!");
368 unsigned Count = 0;
369 while (Val != 1) {
370 if (Val & 1) return 0; // Multiple bits set?
371 Val >>= 1;
372 ++Count;
373 }
374 return Count;
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000375}
376
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000377// AddOne, SubOne - Add or subtract a constant one from an integer constant...
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000378static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
379 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
380 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000381}
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000382static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
383 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
384 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000385}
386
387// isTrueWhenEqual - Return true if the specified setcondinst instruction is
388// true when both operands are equal...
389//
390static bool isTrueWhenEqual(Instruction &I) {
391 return I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ ||
392 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGE ||
393 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLE;
394}
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000395
396/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
397/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
398/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
399/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
400/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
401/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
402/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
403///
404template<typename Functor>
405Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
406 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
407 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
408
409 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
410 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
411 return F.apply(Root);
412
413 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
414 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000415 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000416 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
417 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
418
419 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
420 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
421 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
422 ShouldApply = true;
423 }
424
425 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
426 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
427 if (ShouldApply) {
428 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000429
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000430 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
431 // and perform the reassociation.
432 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
433
434 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
435 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
436
437 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
438 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +0000439 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000440 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
441 return 0;
442 }
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +0000443 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000444 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +0000445 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
446 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
447 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
448 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000449
450 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
451 // get to LHSI.
452 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
453 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +0000454 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
455 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
456 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
457 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
458 ARI = NextLHSI;
459
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000460 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
461 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
462 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
463 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
464 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000465
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000466 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
467 // the transformation...
468 return F.apply(Root);
469 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000470
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000471 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
472 }
473 return 0;
474}
475
476
477// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
478struct AddRHS {
479 Value *RHS;
480 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
481 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
482 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
483 return new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shl, Add.getOperand(0),
484 ConstantInt::get(Type::UByteTy, 1));
485 }
486};
487
488// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
489// iff C1&C2 == 0
490struct AddMaskingAnd {
491 Constant *C2;
492 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
493 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000494 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000495 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000496 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000497 }
498 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000499 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000500 }
501};
502
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000503static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000504 InstCombiner *IC) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000505 if (isa<CastInst>(I)) {
506 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
507 return ConstantExpr::getCast(SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000508
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000509 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(SO, I.getType(),
510 SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
511 }
512
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000513 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000514 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
515 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000516
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000517 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
518 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000519 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
520 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000521 }
522
523 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
524 if (!ConstIsRHS)
525 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
526 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000527 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
528 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
529 else if (ShiftInst *SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(&I))
530 New = new ShiftInst(SI->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1, SO->getName()+".sh");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +0000531 else {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000532 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +0000533 abort();
534 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000535 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
536}
537
538// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
539// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
540// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
541// not have a second operand.
542static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
543 InstCombiner *IC) {
544 // Don't modify shared select instructions
545 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
546 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
547 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
548
549 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +0000550 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
551 if (SI->getType() == Type::BoolTy) return 0;
552
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000553 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
554 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
555
556 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
557 SelectFalseVal);
558 }
559 return 0;
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000560}
561
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000562
563/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
564/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
565/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
566Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
567 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000568 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
569 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0 ||
570 !isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(0))) return 0;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000571
572 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If not, we
573 // cannot do the transformation.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000574 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000575 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)))
576 return 0;
577
578 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
579 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), I.getName());
580 I.setName("");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +0000581 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000582 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
583
584 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
585 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
586 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000587 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000588 Constant *InV = cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i));
589 NewPN->addIncoming(ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InV, C),
590 PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
591 }
592 } else {
593 assert(isa<CastInst>(I) && "Unary op should be a cast!");
594 const Type *RetTy = I.getType();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000595 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000596 Constant *InV = cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i));
597 NewPN->addIncoming(ConstantExpr::getCast(InV, RetTy),
598 PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
599 }
600 }
601 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
602}
603
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000605 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000606 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000607
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000608 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000609 // X + undef -> undef
610 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
611 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
612
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000613 // X + 0 --> X
614 if (!I.getType()->isFloatingPoint() && // -0 + +0 = +0, so it's not a noop
615 RHSC->isNullValue())
616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000617
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000618 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
619 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000620 unsigned NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000621 uint64_t Val = CI->getRawValue() & (1ULL << NumBits)-1;
Chris Lattner33eb9092004-11-05 04:45:43 +0000622 if (Val == (1ULL << (NumBits-1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000623 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000624 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000625
626 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
627 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
628 return NV;
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +0000629 }
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000630
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000631 // X + X --> X << 1
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +0000632 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000633 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +0000634
635 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
636 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
637 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
638 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
639 }
640 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
641 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
642 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
644 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +0000645 }
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +0000646
Chris Lattner147e9752002-05-08 22:46:53 +0000647 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000648 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000649 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000650
651 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000652 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
653 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000654 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000655
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000656
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000657 ConstantInt *C2;
658 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
659 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
660 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
661
662 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
663 ConstantInt *C1;
664 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
665 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000666 }
667
668 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000669 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
670 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
671
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000672
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000673 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000674 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +0000675 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2))) return R;
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000676
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +0000677 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000678 Value *X;
679 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) { // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
680 Constant *C= ConstantExpr::getSub(CRHS, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
681 return BinaryOperator::createSub(C, X);
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +0000682 }
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000683
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +0000684 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
685 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
686 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
687 if (Anded == CRHS) {
688 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
689 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
690 uint64_t AddRHSV = CRHS->getRawValue();
691
692 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
693 uint64_t AddRHSHighBits = ~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1);
Chris Lattner2f1457f2005-04-24 17:46:05 +0000694 AddRHSHighBits &= ~0ULL >> (64-C2->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +0000695
696 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
697 uint64_t AddRHSHighBitsAnd = AddRHSHighBits & C2->getRawValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000698
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +0000699 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
700 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
701 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
702 LHS->getName()), I);
703 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
704 }
705 }
706 }
707
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000708 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
709 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000710 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000711 return R;
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +0000712 }
713
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000714 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000715}
716
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +0000717// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
718// highest order bit set.
719static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000720 unsigned NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner2f1457f2005-04-24 17:46:05 +0000721 return (CI->getRawValue() & (~0ULL >> (64-NumBits))) == (1ULL << (NumBits-1));
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +0000722}
723
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000724/// RemoveNoopCast - Strip off nonconverting casts from the value.
725///
726static Value *RemoveNoopCast(Value *V) {
727 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V)) {
728 const Type *CTy = CI->getType();
729 const Type *OpTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
730 if (CTy->isInteger() && OpTy->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000731 if (CTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == OpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000732 return RemoveNoopCast(CI->getOperand(0));
733 } else if (isa<PointerType>(CTy) && isa<PointerType>(OpTy))
734 return RemoveNoopCast(CI->getOperand(0));
735 }
736 return V;
737}
738
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000739Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000740 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +0000741
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000742 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000744
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000745 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000746 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000747 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000748
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000749 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
751 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
753
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +0000754 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
755 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000756 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
757 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +0000758
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +0000759 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +0000760 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +0000761 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
762 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X,
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000763 ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)));
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000764 // -((uint)X >> 31) -> ((int)X >> 31)
765 // -((int)X >> 31) -> ((uint)X >> 31)
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000766 if (C->isNullValue()) {
767 Value *NoopCastedRHS = RemoveNoopCast(Op1);
768 if (ShiftInst *SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(NoopCastedRHS))
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000769 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shr)
770 if (ConstantUInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
771 const Type *NewTy;
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000772 if (SI->getType()->isSigned())
Chris Lattner97bfcea2004-06-17 18:16:02 +0000773 NewTy = SI->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000774 else
Chris Lattner97bfcea2004-06-17 18:16:02 +0000775 NewTy = SI->getType()->getSignedVersion();
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000776 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000777 if (CU->getValue() == SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000778 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert a cast of the incoming
779 // value, then the new shift, then the new cast.
780 Instruction *FirstCast = new CastInst(SI->getOperand(0), NewTy,
781 SI->getOperand(0)->getName());
782 Value *InV = InsertNewInstBefore(FirstCast, I);
783 Instruction *NewShift = new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, FirstCast,
784 CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000785 if (NewShift->getType() == I.getType())
786 return NewShift;
787 else {
788 InV = InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
789 return new CastInst(NewShift, I.getType());
790 }
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +0000791 }
792 }
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +0000793 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000794
795 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
796 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000797 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000798 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000799
800 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
801 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
802 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +0000803 }
804
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000805 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
806 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
807 !Op0->getType()->isFloatingPoint()) {
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +0000808 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000809 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +0000810 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000811 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +0000812 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
813 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
814 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
815 return BinaryOperator::createSub(ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2),
816 Op1I->getOperand(0));
817 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000818 }
819
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000820 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000821 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
822 // is not used by anyone else...
823 //
Chris Lattnerc2f0aa52004-02-02 20:09:56 +0000824 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
825 !Op1I->getType()->isFloatingPoint()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000826 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
827 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
828 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
829 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000830
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000831 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000832 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000833 }
834
835 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
836 //
837 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
838 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
839 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
840
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +0000841 Value *NewNot =
842 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000843 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000844 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000845
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +0000846 // -(X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
847 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Div)
848 if (ConstantSInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantSInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000849 if (CSI->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +0000850 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000851 return BinaryOperator::createDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +0000852 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
853
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000854 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +0000855 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000856 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000857 Constant *CP1 =
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000858 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000859 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000860 }
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +0000861 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +0000862 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000863
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +0000864 if (!Op0->getType()->isFloatingPoint())
865 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
866 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000867 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
868 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
869 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +0000871 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
872 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
873 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000874 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000875
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000876 ConstantInt *C1;
877 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
878 if (X == Op1) { // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
879 Constant *CP1 = ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(),1));
880 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, CP1);
881 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +0000882
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000883 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
884 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
885 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
886 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +0000887 return 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000888}
889
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000890/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded setcc instruction, return true if it is
891/// really just returns true if the most significant (sign) bit is set.
892static bool isSignBitCheck(unsigned Opcode, Value *LHS, ConstantInt *RHS) {
893 if (RHS->getType()->isSigned()) {
894 // True if source is LHS < 0 or LHS <= -1
895 return Opcode == Instruction::SetLT && RHS->isNullValue() ||
896 Opcode == Instruction::SetLE && RHS->isAllOnesValue();
897 } else {
898 ConstantUInt *RHSC = cast<ConstantUInt>(RHS);
899 // True if source is LHS > 127 or LHS >= 128, where the constants depend on
900 // the size of the integer type.
901 if (Opcode == Instruction::SetGE)
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000902 return RHSC->getValue() ==
903 1ULL << (RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000904 if (Opcode == Instruction::SetGT)
905 return RHSC->getValue() ==
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000906 (1ULL << (RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1))-1;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000907 }
908 return false;
909}
910
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000911Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000912 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000913 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000914
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000915 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
916 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
917
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000918 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000919 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
920 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +0000921
922 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
923 if (ShiftInst *SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(Op0))
924 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
925 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000926 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
927 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000928
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +0000929 if (CI->isNullValue())
930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
931 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
933 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner35236d82003-06-25 17:09:20 +0000934 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +0000935
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +0000936 int64_t Val = (int64_t)cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getRawValue();
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000937 if (uint64_t C = Log2(Val)) // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
938 return new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shl, Op0,
939 ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, C));
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +0000940 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000941 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +0000943
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000944 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
945 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
946 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
948 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000949
950 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
951 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +0000952 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +0000953 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000954
955 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
956 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
957 return NV;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000958 }
959
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +0000960 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
961 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +0000962 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +0000963
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +0000964 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
965 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
966 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
967 // formed.
968 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
969 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
970 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::BoolTy)
971 BoolCast = CI;
972 if (!BoolCast)
973 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
974 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::BoolTy)
975 BoolCast = CI;
976 if (BoolCast) {
977 if (SetCondInst *SCI = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
978 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
979 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
980
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000981 // If the setcc is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
982 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
983 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
984 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getOpcode(), SCIOp0, cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +0000985 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
986 Constant *Amt = ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy,
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000987 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000988 if (SCIOp0->getType()->isUnsigned()) {
Chris Lattner97bfcea2004-06-17 18:16:02 +0000989 const Type *NewTy = SCIOp0->getType()->getSignedVersion();
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000990 SCIOp0 = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(SCIOp0, NewTy,
991 SCIOp0->getName()), I);
992 }
993
994 Value *V =
995 InsertNewInstBefore(new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, SCIOp0, Amt,
996 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
997 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +0000998
999 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
1000 // or truncate to the multiply type.
1001 if (I.getType() != V->getType())
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00001002 V = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(V, I.getType(), V->getName()),I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001003
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00001004 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001005 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00001006 }
1007 }
1008 }
1009
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001010 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001011}
1012
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001013Instruction *InstCombiner::visitDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001014 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001015
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001016 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef / X -> 0
1017 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1018 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
1019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X / undef -> undef
1020
1021 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere20c3342004-04-26 14:01:59 +00001022 // div X, 1 == X
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001023 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001025
Chris Lattnere20c3342004-04-26 14:01:59 +00001026 // div X, -1 == -X
1027 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001028 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
Chris Lattnere20c3342004-04-26 14:01:59 +00001029
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001030 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00001031 if (LHS->getOpcode() == Instruction::Div)
1032 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00001033 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
1034 return BinaryOperator::createDiv(LHS->getOperand(0),
1035 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
1036 }
1037
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001038 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
1039 // if so, convert to a right shift.
1040 if (ConstantUInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(RHS))
1041 if (uint64_t Val = C->getValue()) // Don't break X / 0
1042 if (uint64_t C = Log2(Val))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001043 return new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, Op0,
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001044 ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, C));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001045
Chris Lattner4ad08352004-10-09 02:50:40 +00001046 // -X/C -> X/-C
1047 if (RHS->getType()->isSigned())
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001048 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Chris Lattner4ad08352004-10-09 02:50:40 +00001049 return BinaryOperator::createDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
1050
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001051 if (!RHS->isNullValue()) {
1052 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001053 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001054 return R;
1055 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
1056 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1057 return NV;
1058 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001059 }
1060
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001061 // If this is 'udiv X, (Cond ? C1, C2)' where C1&C2 are powers of two,
1062 // transform this into: '(Cond ? (udiv X, C1) : (udiv X, C2))'.
1063 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
1064 if (ConstantUInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
1065 if (ConstantUInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
1066 if (STO->getValue() == 0) { // Couldn't be this argument.
1067 I.setOperand(1, SFO);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001068 return &I;
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001069 } else if (SFO->getValue() == 0) {
Chris Lattner89dc4f12005-06-16 04:55:52 +00001070 I.setOperand(1, STO);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001071 return &I;
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001072 }
1073
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00001074 uint64_t TVA = STO->getValue(), FVA = SFO->getValue();
1075 unsigned TSA = 0, FSA = 0;
1076 if ((TVA == 1 || (TSA = Log2(TVA))) && // Log2 fails for 0 & 1.
1077 (FVA == 1 || (FSA = Log2(FVA)))) {
1078 Constant *TC = ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, TSA);
1079 Instruction *TSI = new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, Op0,
1080 TC, SI->getName()+".t");
1081 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001082
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00001083 Constant *FC = ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, FSA);
1084 Instruction *FSI = new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, Op0,
1085 FC, SI->getName()+".f");
1086 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
1087 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI);
1088 }
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001089 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001090
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001091 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001092 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001093 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
1094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1095
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001096 return 0;
1097}
1098
1099
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001100Instruction *InstCombiner::visitRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001101 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00001102 if (I.getType()->isSigned())
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001103 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner98c6bdf2004-07-06 07:11:42 +00001104 if (!isa<ConstantSInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Chris Lattner8e726062004-08-09 21:05:48 +00001105 cast<ConstantSInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue() > 0) {
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00001106 // X % -Y -> X % Y
1107 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
1108 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
1109 return &I;
1110 }
1111
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001112 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001113 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001114 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
1115 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001116
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001117 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001118 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
1119 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1120
1121 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
1122 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
1123 if (ConstantUInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(RHS))
1124 if (uint64_t Val = C->getValue()) // Don't break X % 0 (divide by zero)
Chris Lattnerd9e58132004-05-07 15:35:56 +00001125 if (!(Val & (Val-1))) // Power of 2
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001126 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0,
1127 ConstantUInt::get(I.getType(), Val-1));
1128
1129 if (!RHS->isNullValue()) {
1130 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001131 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001132 return R;
1133 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
1134 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1135 return NV;
1136 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001137 }
1138
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001139 // If this is 'urem X, (Cond ? C1, C2)' where C1&C2 are powers of two,
1140 // transform this into: '(Cond ? (urem X, C1) : (urem X, C2))'.
1141 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
1142 if (ConstantUInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
1143 if (ConstantUInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
1144 if (STO->getValue() == 0) { // Couldn't be this argument.
1145 I.setOperand(1, SFO);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001146 return &I;
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001147 } else if (SFO->getValue() == 0) {
1148 I.setOperand(1, STO);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001149 return &I;
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001150 }
1151
1152 if (!(STO->getValue() & (STO->getValue()-1)) &&
1153 !(SFO->getValue() & (SFO->getValue()-1))) {
1154 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0,
1155 SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
1156 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0,
1157 SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
1158 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
1159 }
1160 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001161
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001162 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00001163 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001164 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1166
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001167 return 0;
1168}
1169
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001170// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001171static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C) {
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001172 if (const ConstantUInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(C)) {
1173 // Calculate -1 casted to the right type...
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00001174 unsigned TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001175 uint64_t Val = ~0ULL; // All ones
1176 Val >>= 64-TypeBits; // Shift out unwanted 1 bits...
1177 return CU->getValue() == Val-1;
1178 }
1179
1180 const ConstantSInt *CS = cast<ConstantSInt>(C);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001181
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001182 // Calculate 0111111111..11111
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00001183 unsigned TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001184 int64_t Val = INT64_MAX; // All ones
1185 Val >>= 64-TypeBits; // Shift out unwanted 1 bits...
1186 return CS->getValue() == Val-1;
1187}
1188
1189// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001190static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C) {
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001191 if (const ConstantUInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(C))
1192 return CU->getValue() == 1;
1193
1194 const ConstantSInt *CS = cast<ConstantSInt>(C);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001195
1196 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00001197 unsigned TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001198 int64_t Val = -1; // All ones
1199 Val <<= TypeBits-1; // Shift over to the right spot
1200 return CS->getValue() == Val+1;
1201}
1202
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00001203// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
1204// constant.
1205static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
1206 uint64_t V = CI->getRawValue();
1207 return V && (V & (V-1)) == 0;
1208}
1209
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00001210#if 0 // Currently unused
1211// isLowOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 0+1+.
1212static bool isLowOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
1213 uint64_t V = CI->getRawValue();
1214
1215 // There won't be bits set in parts that the type doesn't contain.
1216 V &= ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI->getType())->getRawValue();
1217
1218 uint64_t U = V+1; // If it is low ones, this should be a power of two.
1219 return U && V && (U & V) == 0;
1220}
1221#endif
1222
1223// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
1224// This is the same as lowones(~X).
1225static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
1226 uint64_t V = ~CI->getRawValue();
1227
1228 // There won't be bits set in parts that the type doesn't contain.
1229 V &= ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI->getType())->getRawValue();
1230
1231 uint64_t U = V+1; // If it is low ones, this should be a power of two.
1232 return U && V && (U & V) == 0;
1233}
1234
1235
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00001236/// getSetCondCode - Encode a setcc opcode into a three bit mask. These bits
1237/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
1238///
1239/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
1240///
1241/// Bit value '4' represents that the comparison is true if A > B, bit value '2'
1242/// represents that the comparison is true if A == B, and bit value '1' is true
1243/// if A < B.
1244///
1245static unsigned getSetCondCode(const SetCondInst *SCI) {
1246 switch (SCI->getOpcode()) {
1247 // False -> 0
1248 case Instruction::SetGT: return 1;
1249 case Instruction::SetEQ: return 2;
1250 case Instruction::SetGE: return 3;
1251 case Instruction::SetLT: return 4;
1252 case Instruction::SetNE: return 5;
1253 case Instruction::SetLE: return 6;
1254 // True -> 7
1255 default:
1256 assert(0 && "Invalid SetCC opcode!");
1257 return 0;
1258 }
1259}
1260
1261/// getSetCCValue - This is the complement of getSetCondCode, which turns an
1262/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand new
1263/// SetCC instruction.
1264static Value *getSetCCValue(unsigned Opcode, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1265 switch (Opcode) {
1266 case 0: return ConstantBool::False;
1267 case 1: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGT, LHS, RHS);
1268 case 2: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetEQ, LHS, RHS);
1269 case 3: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGE, LHS, RHS);
1270 case 4: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, LHS, RHS);
1271 case 5: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetNE, LHS, RHS);
1272 case 6: return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLE, LHS, RHS);
1273 case 7: return ConstantBool::True;
1274 default: assert(0 && "Illegal SetCCCode!"); return 0;
1275 }
1276}
1277
1278// FoldSetCCLogical - Implements (setcc1 A, B) & (setcc2 A, B) --> (setcc3 A, B)
1279struct FoldSetCCLogical {
1280 InstCombiner &IC;
1281 Value *LHS, *RHS;
1282 FoldSetCCLogical(InstCombiner &ic, SetCondInst *SCI)
1283 : IC(ic), LHS(SCI->getOperand(0)), RHS(SCI->getOperand(1)) {}
1284 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
1285 if (SetCondInst *SCI = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(V))
1286 return (SCI->getOperand(0) == LHS && SCI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
1287 SCI->getOperand(0) == RHS && SCI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
1288 return false;
1289 }
1290 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Log) const {
1291 SetCondInst *SCI = cast<SetCondInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
1292 if (SCI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
1293 assert(SCI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
1294 SCI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the SetCC
1295 }
1296
1297 unsigned LHSCode = getSetCondCode(SCI);
1298 unsigned RHSCode = getSetCondCode(cast<SetCondInst>(Log.getOperand(1)));
1299 unsigned Code;
1300 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
1301 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
1302 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
1303 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner2caaaba2003-09-22 20:33:34 +00001304 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00001305 }
1306
1307 Value *RV = getSetCCValue(Code, LHS, RHS);
1308 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
1309 return I;
1310 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
1311 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
1312 }
1313};
1314
1315
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001316/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
1317/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. V and Mask are known to
1318/// be the same type.
1319static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, ConstantIntegral *Mask) {
Chris Lattner18aa4d82005-07-20 18:49:28 +00001320 // Note, we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
1321 // we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00001322 // to to an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
Chris Lattner18aa4d82005-07-20 18:49:28 +00001323 // optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
1324 // Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
1325 // this won't lose us code quality.
1326 if (Mask->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001327 return true;
1328 if (ConstantIntegral *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(V))
1329 return ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI, Mask)->isNullValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001330
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001331 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
1332 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1333 case Instruction::And:
1334 // (X & C1) & C2 == 0 iff C1 & C2 == 0.
1335 if (ConstantIntegral *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(I->getOperand(1)))
1336 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI, Mask)->isNullValue())
1337 return true;
1338 break;
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001339 case Instruction::Or:
1340 // If the LHS and the RHS are MaskedValueIsZero, the result is also zero.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001341 return MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001342 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask);
1343 case Instruction::Select:
1344 // If the T and F values are MaskedValueIsZero, the result is also zero.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001345 return MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(2), Mask) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001346 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001347 case Instruction::Cast: {
1348 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00001349 if (SrcTy == Type::BoolTy)
1350 return (Mask->getRawValue() & 1) == 0;
1351
1352 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001353 // (cast <ty> X to int) & C2 == 0 iff <ty> could not have contained C2.
1354 if (SrcTy->isUnsigned() && // Only handle zero ext.
1355 ConstantExpr::getCast(Mask, SrcTy)->isNullValue())
1356 return true;
1357
1358 // If this is a noop cast, recurse.
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00001359 if ((SrcTy->isSigned() && SrcTy->getUnsignedVersion() == I->getType())||
1360 SrcTy->getSignedVersion() == I->getType()) {
1361 Constant *NewMask =
1362 ConstantExpr::getCast(Mask, I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1363 return MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
1364 cast<ConstantIntegral>(NewMask));
1365 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001366 }
1367 break;
1368 }
1369 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattneref298a32005-05-06 04:53:20 +00001370 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
1371 if (ConstantUInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(I->getOperand(1)))
1372 return MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
1373 cast<ConstantIntegral>(ConstantExpr::getUShr(Mask, SA)));
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001374 break;
1375 case Instruction::Shr:
1376 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
1377 if (ConstantUInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(I->getOperand(1)))
1378 if (I->getType()->isUnsigned()) {
1379 Constant *C1 = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
1380 C1 = ConstantExpr::getShr(C1, SA);
1381 C1 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, Mask);
1382 if (C1->isNullValue())
1383 return true;
1384 }
1385 break;
1386 }
1387 }
1388
1389 return false;
1390}
1391
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001392// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
1393// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
1394// guaranteed to be either a shift instruction or a binary operator.
1395Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
1396 ConstantIntegral *OpRHS,
1397 ConstantIntegral *AndRHS,
1398 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
1399 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerfcf21a72004-01-12 19:47:05 +00001400 Constant *Together = 0;
1401 if (!isa<ShiftInst>(Op))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001402 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00001403
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001404 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
1405 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001406 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001407 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
1408 std::string OpName = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001409 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS, OpName);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001410 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001411 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001412 }
1413 break;
1414 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001415 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
1416 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001417
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001418 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
1419 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
1420 std::string Op0Name = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
1421 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together, Op0Name);
1422 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
1423 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001424 }
1425 break;
1426 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001427 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001428 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
1429 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
1430 // single bit constant.
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00001431 uint64_t AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getRawValue();
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001432
1433 // Clear bits that are not part of the constant.
Chris Lattner2f1457f2005-04-24 17:46:05 +00001434 AndRHSV &= ~0ULL >> (64-AndRHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001435
1436 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00001437 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001438 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
1439 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
1440 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00001441 uint64_t AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getRawValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001442
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001443 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
1444 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
1445 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
1446 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
1447 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
1448 // no effect.
1449 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
1450 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
1451 return &TheAnd;
1452 } else {
1453 std::string Name = Op->getName(); Op->setName("");
1454 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001455 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS, Name);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001456 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001457 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001458 }
1459 }
1460 }
1461 }
1462 break;
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00001463
1464 case Instruction::Shl: {
1465 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
1466 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
1467 //
1468 Constant *AllOne = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001469 Constant *ShlMask = ConstantExpr::getShl(AllOne, OpRHS);
1470 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001471
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001472 if (CI == ShlMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
1473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
1474 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00001475 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
1476 return &TheAnd;
1477 }
1478 break;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001479 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00001480 case Instruction::Shr:
1481 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
1482 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
1483 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
1484 //
1485 if (AndRHS->getType()->isUnsigned()) {
1486 Constant *AllOne = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001487 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
1488 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
1489
1490 if (CI == ShrMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
1491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
1492 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
1493 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00001494 return &TheAnd;
1495 }
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001496 } else { // Signed shr.
1497 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
1498 // with an and.
1499 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
1500 Constant *AllOne = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
1501 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getUShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
1502 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
Chris Lattner5c3c21e2004-10-22 04:53:16 +00001503 if (CI == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001504 // Make the argument unsigned.
1505 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
1506 ShVal = InsertCastBefore(ShVal,
1507 ShVal->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(),
1508 TheAnd);
1509 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, ShVal,
1510 OpRHS, Op->getName()),
1511 TheAnd);
Chris Lattner70c20392004-10-27 05:57:15 +00001512 Value *AndRHS2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(AndRHS, ShVal->getType());
1513 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS2,
1514 TheAnd.getName()),
1515 TheAnd);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00001516 return new CastInst(ShVal, Op->getType());
1517 }
1518 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00001519 }
1520 break;
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001521 }
1522 return 0;
1523}
1524
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00001525
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00001526/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
1527/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
1528/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. IB is the location to
1529/// insert new instructions.
1530Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
1531 bool Inside, Instruction &IB) {
1532 assert(cast<ConstantBool>(ConstantExpr::getSetLE(Lo, Hi))->getValue() &&
1533 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
1534 if (Inside) {
1535 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
1536 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetNE, V, V);
1537 if (cast<ConstantIntegral>(Lo)->isMinValue())
1538 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, V, Hi);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001539
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00001540 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
1541 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, AddCST,V->getName()+".off");
1542 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
1543 // Convert to unsigned for the comparison.
1544 const Type *UnsType = Add->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
1545 Value *OffsetVal = InsertCastBefore(Add, UnsType, IB);
1546 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getAdd(AddCST, Hi);
1547 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getCast(AddCST, UnsType);
1548 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, OffsetVal, AddCST);
1549 }
1550
1551 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
1552 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetEQ, V, V);
1553
1554 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
1555 if (cast<ConstantIntegral>(Lo)->isMinValue()) // V < 0 || V >= Hi ->'V > Hi-1'
1556 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGT, V, Hi);
1557
1558 // Emit X-Lo > Hi-Lo-1
1559 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
1560 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, AddCST, V->getName()+".off");
1561 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
1562 // Convert to unsigned for the comparison.
1563 const Type *UnsType = Add->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
1564 Value *OffsetVal = InsertCastBefore(Add, UnsType, IB);
1565 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getAdd(AddCST, Hi);
1566 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getCast(AddCST, UnsType);
1567 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGT, OffsetVal, AddCST);
1568}
1569
1570
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001571Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001572 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001573 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001574
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001575 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
1576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1577
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001578 // and X, X = X
1579 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001580 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001581
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001582 if (ConstantIntegral *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001583 // and X, -1 == X
1584 if (AndRHS->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001586
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001587 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, AndRHS)) // LHS & RHS == 0
1588 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1589
1590 // If the mask is not masking out any bits, there is no reason to do the
1591 // and in the first place.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001592 ConstantIntegral *NotAndRHS =
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001593 cast<ConstantIntegral>(ConstantExpr::getNot(AndRHS));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001594 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, NotAndRHS))
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001595 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001596
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001597 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
1598 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0) || isa<ShiftInst>(Op0)) {
1599 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001600 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
1601 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
1602 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
1603 case Instruction::Xor:
1604 case Instruction::Or:
1605 // (X ^ V) & C2 --> (X & C2) iff (V & C2) == 0
1606 // (X | V) & C2 --> (X & C2) iff (V & C2) == 0
1607 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, AndRHS))
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001608 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001609 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, AndRHS))
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001610 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001611
1612 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
1613 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
1614 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
1615 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
1616 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
1617 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
1618 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
1619 return BinaryOperator::create(
1620 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001621 }
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00001622 if (!isa<Constant>(NotAndRHS) &&
1623 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
1624 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
1625 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
1626 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
1627 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
1628 return BinaryOperator::create(
1629 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
1630 }
1631 }
1632
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001633 break;
1634 case Instruction::And:
1635 // (X & V) & C2 --> 0 iff (V & C2) == 0
1636 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, AndRHS) ||
1637 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, AndRHS))
1638 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1639 break;
1640 }
1641
Chris Lattner16464b32003-07-23 19:25:52 +00001642 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001643 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00001644 return Res;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001645 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
1646 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
1647
1648 // If this is an integer sign or zero extension instruction.
1649 if (SrcTy->isIntegral() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00001650 SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <
1651 CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001652
1653 if (SrcTy->isUnsigned()) {
1654 // See if this and is clearing out bits that are known to be zero
1655 // anyway (due to the zero extension).
1656 Constant *Mask = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
1657 Mask = ConstantExpr::getZeroExtend(Mask, CI->getType());
1658 Constant *Result = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Mask, AndRHS);
1659 if (Result == Mask) // The "and" isn't doing anything, remove it.
1660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
1661 if (Result != AndRHS) { // Reduce the and RHS constant.
1662 I.setOperand(1, Result);
1663 return &I;
1664 }
1665
1666 } else {
1667 if (CI->hasOneUse() && SrcTy->isInteger()) {
1668 // We can only do this if all of the sign bits brought in are masked
1669 // out. Compute this by first getting 0000011111, then inverting
1670 // it.
1671 Constant *Mask = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
1672 Mask = ConstantExpr::getZeroExtend(Mask, CI->getType());
1673 Mask = ConstantExpr::getNot(Mask); // 1's in the new bits.
1674 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(Mask, AndRHS)->isNullValue()) {
1675 // If the and is clearing all of the sign bits, change this to a
1676 // zero extension cast. To do this, cast the cast input to
1677 // unsigned, then to the requested size.
1678 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
1679 Instruction *NC =
1680 new CastInst(CastOp, CastOp->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(),
1681 CI->getName()+".uns");
1682 NC = InsertNewInstBefore(NC, I);
1683 // Finally, insert a replacement for CI.
1684 NC = new CastInst(NC, CI->getType(), CI->getName());
1685 CI->setName("");
1686 NC = InsertNewInstBefore(NC, I);
1687 WorkList.push_back(CI); // Delete CI later.
1688 I.setOperand(0, NC);
1689 return &I; // The AND operand was modified.
1690 }
1691 }
1692 }
1693 }
Chris Lattner33217db2003-07-23 19:36:21 +00001694 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001695
1696 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
1697 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001698 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001699 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001700 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
1701 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1702 return NV;
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00001703 }
1704
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001705 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
1706 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001707
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00001708 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
1709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
1710
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00001711 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001712 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001713 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
1714 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00001715 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001716 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
1717 }
1718
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00001719 if (SetCondInst *RHS = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(Op1)) {
1720 // (setcc1 A, B) & (setcc2 A, B) --> (setcc3 A, B)
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00001721 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldSetCCLogical(*this, RHS)))
1722 return R;
1723
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00001724 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
1725 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
1726 Instruction::BinaryOps LHSCC, RHSCC;
1727 if (match(Op0, m_SetCond(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
1728 if (match(RHS, m_SetCond(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
1729 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X setcc C1) & (X setcc C2)
1730 // Set[GL]E X, CST is folded to Set[GL]T elsewhere.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001731 LHSCC != Instruction::SetGE && LHSCC != Instruction::SetLE &&
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00001732 RHSCC != Instruction::SetGE && RHSCC != Instruction::SetLE) {
1733 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
1734 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getSetGT(LHSCst, RHSCst);
1735 SetCondInst *LHS = cast<SetCondInst>(Op0);
1736 if (cast<ConstantBool>(Cmp)->getValue()) {
1737 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
1738 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
1739 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
1740 }
1741
1742 // At this point, we know we have have two setcc instructions
1743 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
1744 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
1745 // SetEQ, SetNE, SetLT, and SetGT here. We also know (from the
1746 // FoldSetCCLogical check above), that the two constants are not
1747 // equal.
1748 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
1749
1750 switch (LHSCC) {
1751 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1752 case Instruction::SetEQ:
1753 switch (RHSCC) {
1754 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1755 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
1756 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
1757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
1758 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
1759 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
1760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
1761 }
1762 case Instruction::SetNE:
1763 switch (RHSCC) {
1764 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1765 case Instruction::SetLT:
1766 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X < 14) -> X < 13
1767 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
1768 break; // (X != 13 & X < 15) -> no change
1769 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
1770 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X != 13 & X > 15) -> X > 15
1771 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1772 case Instruction::SetNE:
1773 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
1774 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
1775 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
1776 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
1777 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
1778 const Type *UnsType = Add->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
1779 Value *OffsetVal = InsertCastBefore(Add, UnsType, I);
1780 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(RHSCst, LHSCst);
1781 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getCast(AddCST, UnsType);
1782 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGT, OffsetVal, AddCST);
1783 }
1784 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
1785 }
1786 break;
1787 case Instruction::SetLT:
1788 switch (RHSCC) {
1789 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1790 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X < 13 & X == 15) -> false
1791 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X < 13 & X > 15) -> false
1792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
1793 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X < 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
1794 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X < 13 & X < 15) -> X < 13
1795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
1796 }
1797 case Instruction::SetGT:
1798 switch (RHSCC) {
1799 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1800 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X > 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
1801 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
1802 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X > 13 & X > 15) -> X > 15
1803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1804 case Instruction::SetNE:
1805 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X > 13 & X != 14) -> X > 14
1806 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGT, LHSVal, RHSCst);
1807 break; // (X > 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00001808 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X > 13 & X < 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
1809 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true, I);
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00001810 }
1811 }
1812 }
1813 }
1814
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001815 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001816}
1817
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001818Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001819 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001820 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001821
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001822 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
1823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // X | undef -> -1
1824 ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
1825
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001826 // or X, X = X or X, 0 == X
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001827 if (Op0 == Op1 || Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()))
1828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001829
1830 // or X, -1 == -1
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00001831 if (ConstantIntegral *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001832 // If X is known to only contain bits that already exist in RHS, just
1833 // replace this instruction with RHS directly.
1834 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
1835 cast<ConstantIntegral>(ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS))))
1836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00001837
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001838 ConstantInt *C1; Value *X;
1839 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
1840 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00001841 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS, Op0->getName());
1842 Op0->setName("");
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001843 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
1844 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, ConstantExpr::getOr(RHS, C1));
1845 }
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00001846
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001847 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
1848 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
1849 std::string Op0Name = Op0->getName(); Op0->setName("");
1850 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS, Op0Name);
1851 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
1852 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
1853 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS)));
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00001854 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001855
1856 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
1857 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001858 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001859 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001860 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
1861 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1862 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00001863 }
1864
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001865 Value *A, *B; ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00001866
1867 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
1868 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
1869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
1870 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
1871 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
1872 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
1873
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00001874 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
1875 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
1876 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1)) {
1877 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1, Op0->getName());
1878 Op0->setName("");
1879 return BinaryOperator::createXor(InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I), C1);
1880 }
1881
1882 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
1883 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
1884 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1)) {
1885 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0, Op1->getName());
1886 Op0->setName("");
1887 return BinaryOperator::createXor(InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I), C1);
1888 }
1889
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00001890 // (A & C1)|(A & C2) == A & (C1|C2)
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001891 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
1892 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2))) && A == B)
1893 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, ConstantExpr::getOr(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner812aab72003-08-12 19:11:07 +00001894
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001895 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
1896 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001898 ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
1899 } else {
1900 A = 0;
1901 }
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00001902 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001903 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
1904 if (Op0 == B)
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001906 ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00001907
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00001908 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001909 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
1910 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
1911 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
1912 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
1913 }
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00001914 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00001915
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00001916 // (setcc1 A, B) | (setcc2 A, B) --> (setcc3 A, B)
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001917 if (SetCondInst *RHS = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00001918 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldSetCCLogical(*this, RHS)))
1919 return R;
1920
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001921 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
1922 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
1923 Instruction::BinaryOps LHSCC, RHSCC;
1924 if (match(Op0, m_SetCond(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
1925 if (match(RHS, m_SetCond(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
1926 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X setcc C1) | (X setcc C2)
1927 // Set[GL]E X, CST is folded to Set[GL]T elsewhere.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001928 LHSCC != Instruction::SetGE && LHSCC != Instruction::SetLE &&
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001929 RHSCC != Instruction::SetGE && RHSCC != Instruction::SetLE) {
1930 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
1931 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getSetGT(LHSCst, RHSCst);
1932 SetCondInst *LHS = cast<SetCondInst>(Op0);
1933 if (cast<ConstantBool>(Cmp)->getValue()) {
1934 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
1935 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
1936 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
1937 }
1938
1939 // At this point, we know we have have two setcc instructions
1940 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
1941 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
1942 // SetEQ, SetNE, SetLT, and SetGT here. We also know (from the
1943 // FoldSetCCLogical check above), that the two constants are not
1944 // equal.
1945 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
1946
1947 switch (LHSCC) {
1948 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1949 case Instruction::SetEQ:
1950 switch (RHSCC) {
1951 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1952 case Instruction::SetEQ:
1953 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
1954 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
1955 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
1956 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
1957 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
1958 const Type *UnsType = Add->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
1959 Value *OffsetVal = InsertCastBefore(Add, UnsType, I);
1960 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
1961 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getCast(AddCST, UnsType);
1962 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, OffsetVal, AddCST);
1963 }
1964 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
1965
Chris Lattner5c219462005-04-19 06:04:18 +00001966 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X == 13 | X > 14) -> no change
1967 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001968 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
1969 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X == 13 | X < 15) -> X < 15
1970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1971 }
1972 break;
1973 case Instruction::SetNE:
1974 switch (RHSCC) {
1975 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001976 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
1977 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X != 13 | X > 15) -> X != 13
1978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
1979 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
Chris Lattner2ceb6ee2005-06-17 03:59:17 +00001980 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X != 13 | X < 15) -> true
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
1982 }
1983 break;
1984 case Instruction::SetLT:
1985 switch (RHSCC) {
1986 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1987 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X < 13 | X == 14) -> no change
1988 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00001989 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X < 13 | X > 15) -> (X-13) > 2
1990 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false, I);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00001991 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X < 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
1992 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X < 13 | X < 15) -> X < 15
1993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1994 }
1995 break;
1996 case Instruction::SetGT:
1997 switch (RHSCC) {
1998 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
1999 case Instruction::SetEQ: // (X > 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
2000 case Instruction::SetGT: // (X > 13 | X > 15) -> X > 13
2001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2002 case Instruction::SetNE: // (X > 13 | X != 15) -> true
2003 case Instruction::SetLT: // (X > 13 | X < 15) -> true
2004 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
2005 }
2006 }
2007 }
2008 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002009 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002010}
2011
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00002012// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
2013struct XorSelf {
2014 Value *RHS;
2015 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
2016 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
2017 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
2018 return &Xor;
2019 }
2020};
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002021
2022
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002023Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002024 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002025 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002026
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002027 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
2029
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00002030 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
2031 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
2032 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00002034 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002035
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002036 if (ConstantIntegral *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantIntegral>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002037 // xor X, 0 == X
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002038 if (RHS->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002039 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002040
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002041 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00002042 // xor (setcc A, B), true = not (setcc A, B) = setncc A, B
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002043 if (SetCondInst *SCI = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(Op0I))
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002044 if (RHS == ConstantBool::True && SCI->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00002045 return new SetCondInst(SCI->getInverseCondition(),
2046 SCI->getOperand(0), SCI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00002047
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002048 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002049 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2050 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002051 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
2052 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002053 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002054 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002055 }
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00002056
2057 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y)
2058 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
2059 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
2060 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
2061 Instruction *NotY =
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002062 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00002063 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
2064 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
2065 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
2066 }
2067 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002068
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002069 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00002070 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
2071 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00002072 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002073 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002074 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
2075 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
2076 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002077 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00002078 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002079 }
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00002080 break;
2081 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002082 // (X & C1) ^ C2 --> (X & C1) | C2 iff (C1&C2) == 0
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002083 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(RHS, Op0CI)->isNullValue())
2084 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0, RHS);
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00002085 break;
2086 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002087 // (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002088 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(RHS, Op0CI) == RHS)
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00002089 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00002090 break;
2091 default: break;
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00002092 }
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00002093 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002094
2095 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
2096 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002097 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002098 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002099 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2100 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2101 return NV;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002102 }
2103
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002104 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002105 if (X == Op1)
2106 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
2107 ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
2108
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002109 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002110 if (X == Op0)
2111 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
2112 ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
2113
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002114 if (Instruction *Op1I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1))
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00002115 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002116 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
2117 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1I)->swapOperands();
2118 I.swapOperands();
2119 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
2120 } else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
2121 I.swapOperands();
2122 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002123 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00002124 } else if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
2125 if (Op0 == Op1I->getOperand(0)) // A^(A^B) == B
2126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1I->getOperand(1));
2127 else if (Op0 == Op1I->getOperand(1)) // A^(B^A) == B
2128 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1I->getOperand(0));
2129 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002130
2131 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002132 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002133 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
2134 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002135 if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002136 Value *NotB = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1,
2137 Op1->getName()+".not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002138 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), NotB);
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002139 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00002140 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
2141 if (Op1 == Op0I->getOperand(0)) // (A^B)^A == B
2142 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2143 else if (Op1 == Op0I->getOperand(1)) // (B^A)^A == B
2144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00002145 }
2146
Chris Lattner7aa2d472004-08-01 19:42:59 +00002147 // (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002148 Value *A, *B; ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
2149 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
2150 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2))) &&
Chris Lattner7aa2d472004-08-01 19:42:59 +00002151 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002152 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002153
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002154 // (setcc1 A, B) ^ (setcc2 A, B) --> (setcc3 A, B)
2155 if (SetCondInst *RHS = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
2156 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldSetCCLogical(*this, RHS)))
2157 return R;
2158
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002159 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002160}
2161
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002162/// MulWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1*In2, returning true if the result
2163/// overflowed for this type.
2164static bool MulWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
2165 ConstantInt *In2) {
2166 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getMul(In1, In2));
2167 return !In2->isNullValue() && ConstantExpr::getDiv(Result, In2) != In1;
2168}
2169
2170static bool isPositive(ConstantInt *C) {
2171 return cast<ConstantSInt>(C)->getValue() >= 0;
2172}
2173
2174/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
2175/// overflowed for this type.
2176static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
2177 ConstantInt *In2) {
2178 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2));
2179
2180 if (In1->getType()->isUnsigned())
2181 return cast<ConstantUInt>(Result)->getValue() <
2182 cast<ConstantUInt>(In1)->getValue();
2183 if (isPositive(In1) != isPositive(In2))
2184 return false;
2185 if (isPositive(In1))
2186 return cast<ConstantSInt>(Result)->getValue() <
2187 cast<ConstantSInt>(In1)->getValue();
2188 return cast<ConstantSInt>(Result)->getValue() >
2189 cast<ConstantSInt>(In1)->getValue();
2190}
2191
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002192/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
2193/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
2194/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
2195static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
2196 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
2197 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
2198 const Type *UIntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
2199 const Type *SIntPtrTy = UIntPtrTy->getSignedVersion();
2200 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(SIntPtrTy);
2201
2202 // Build a mask for high order bits.
2203 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL;
2204 PtrSizeMask >>= 64-(TD.getPointerSize()*8);
2205
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002206 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
2207 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattnerd35d2102005-01-13 23:26:48 +00002208 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002209 Constant *Scale = ConstantExpr::getCast(ConstantUInt::get(UIntPtrTy, Size),
2210 SIntPtrTy);
2211 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
2212 if (!OpC->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00002213 OpC = ConstantExpr::getCast(OpC, SIntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002214 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
2215 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
2216 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
2217 else {
2218 // Emit an add instruction.
2219 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
2220 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
2221 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
2222 }
2223 }
2224 } else {
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00002225 // Convert to correct type.
2226 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(Op, SIntPtrTy,
2227 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
2228 if (Size != 1)
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00002229 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
2230 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
2231 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002232
2233 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00002234 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002235 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
2236 }
2237 }
2238 return Result;
2239}
2240
2241/// FoldGEPSetCC - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
2242/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
2243Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPSetCC(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
2244 Instruction::BinaryOps Cond,
2245 Instruction &I) {
2246 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002247
2248 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
2249 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
2250 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
2251
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002252 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
2253 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
2254 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
2255 // OFFSET if this is a seteq or setne comparison, just return whether each
2256 // index is zero or not.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002257 if (Cond == Instruction::SetEQ || Cond == Instruction::SetNE) {
2258 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00002259 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
2260 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002261 bool EmitIt = true;
2262 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
2263 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
2264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2265 if (C->isNullValue())
2266 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00002267 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
2268 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002269 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
2271 ConstantBool::get(Cond == Instruction::SetNE));
2272 }
2273
2274 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002275 Instruction *Comp =
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002276 new SetCondInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
2277 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
2278 if (InVal == 0)
2279 InVal = Comp;
2280 else {
2281 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
2282 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
2283 if (Cond == Instruction::SetNE) // True if any are unequal
2284 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
2285 else // True if all are equal
2286 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
2287 }
2288 }
2289 }
2290
2291 if (InVal)
2292 return InVal;
2293 else
2294 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
2295 ConstantBool::get(Cond == Instruction::SetEQ));
2296 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002297
2298 // Only lower this if the setcc is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
2299 // the result to fold to a constant!
2300 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
2301 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
2302 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
2303 return new SetCondInst(Cond, Offset,
2304 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
2305 }
2306 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00002307 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
2308 // compare the base pointer.
2309 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
2310 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00002311 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattnerbd43b9d2005-04-26 14:40:41 +00002312 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00002313 if (IndicesTheSame)
2314 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
2315 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
2316 IndicesTheSame = false;
2317 break;
2318 }
2319
2320 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
2321 if (IndicesTheSame)
2322 return new SetCondInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
2323 GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
2324
2325 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
2326 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002327 return 0;
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00002328 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002329
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002330 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
2331 bool AllZeros = true;
2332 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
2333 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
2334 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
2335 AllZeros = false;
2336 break;
2337 }
2338 if (AllZeros)
2339 return FoldGEPSetCC(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
2340 SetCondInst::getSwappedCondition(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00002341
2342 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00002343 AllZeros = true;
2344 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
2345 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
2346 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
2347 AllZeros = false;
2348 break;
2349 }
2350 if (AllZeros)
2351 return FoldGEPSetCC(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
2352
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00002353 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
2354 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
2355 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
2356 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
2357 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
2358 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002359 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
2360 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00002361 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00002362 NumDifferences = 2;
2363 break;
2364 } else {
2365 if (NumDifferences++) break;
2366 DiffOperand = i;
2367 }
2368 }
2369
2370 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
2371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
2372 ConstantBool::get(Cond == Instruction::SetEQ));
2373 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00002374 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
2375 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Chris Lattner247aef82005-07-18 23:07:33 +00002376
2377 // Convert the operands to signed values to make sure to perform a
2378 // signed comparison.
2379 const Type *NewTy = LHSV->getType()->getSignedVersion();
2380 if (LHSV->getType() != NewTy)
2381 LHSV = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(LHSV, NewTy,
2382 LHSV->getName()), I);
2383 if (RHSV->getType() != NewTy)
2384 RHSV = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(RHSV, NewTy,
2385 RHSV->getName()), I);
2386 return new SetCondInst(Cond, LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00002387 }
2388 }
2389
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002390 // Only lower this if the setcc is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
2391 // the result to fold to a constant!
2392 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
2393 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
2394 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
2395 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
2396 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
2397 return new SetCondInst(Cond, L, R);
2398 }
2399 }
2400 return 0;
2401}
2402
2403
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002404Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSetCondInst(SetCondInst &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002405 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002406 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2407 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002408
2409 // setcc X, X
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002410 if (Op0 == Op1)
2411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::get(isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner1fc23f32002-05-09 20:11:54 +00002412
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002413 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X setcc undef -> undef
2414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::BoolTy));
2415
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00002416 // setcc <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
2417 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002418 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
2419 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
2420 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00002421 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::get(!isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
2423
2424 // setcc's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
2425 if (Ty == Type::BoolTy) {
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00002426 switch (I.getOpcode()) {
2427 default: assert(0 && "Invalid setcc instruction!");
2428 case Instruction::SetEQ: { // seteq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002429 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002430 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00002431 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002432 }
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00002433 case Instruction::SetNE:
2434 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002435
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00002436 case Instruction::SetGT:
2437 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change setgt -> setlt
2438 // FALL THROUGH
2439 case Instruction::SetLT: { // setlt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
2440 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
2441 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
2442 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
2443 }
2444 case Instruction::SetGE:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002445 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change setge -> setle
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00002446 // FALL THROUGH
2447 case Instruction::SetLE: { // setle bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
2448 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
2449 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
2450 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
2451 }
2452 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002453 }
2454
Chris Lattner2dd01742004-06-09 04:24:29 +00002455 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
2456 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002457 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002458 // Check to see if we are comparing against the minimum or maximum value...
2459 if (CI->isMinValue()) {
2460 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT) // A < MIN -> FALSE
2461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2462 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGE) // A >= MIN -> TRUE
2463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
2464 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLE) // A <= MIN -> A == MIN
2465 return BinaryOperator::createSetEQ(Op0, Op1);
2466 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGT) // A > MIN -> A != MIN
2467 return BinaryOperator::createSetNE(Op0, Op1);
2468
2469 } else if (CI->isMaxValue()) {
2470 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGT) // A > MAX -> FALSE
2471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2472 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLE) // A <= MAX -> TRUE
2473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
2474 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGE) // A >= MAX -> A == MAX
2475 return BinaryOperator::createSetEQ(Op0, Op1);
2476 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT) // A < MAX -> A != MAX
2477 return BinaryOperator::createSetNE(Op0, Op1);
2478
2479 // Comparing against a value really close to min or max?
2480 } else if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI)) {
2481 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT) // A < MIN+1 -> A == MIN
2482 return BinaryOperator::createSetEQ(Op0, SubOne(CI));
2483 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGE) // A >= MIN-1 -> A != MIN
2484 return BinaryOperator::createSetNE(Op0, SubOne(CI));
2485
2486 } else if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI)) {
2487 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGT) // A > MAX-1 -> A == MAX
2488 return BinaryOperator::createSetEQ(Op0, AddOne(CI));
2489 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLE) // A <= MAX-1 -> A != MAX
2490 return BinaryOperator::createSetNE(Op0, AddOne(CI));
2491 }
2492
2493 // If we still have a setle or setge instruction, turn it into the
2494 // appropriate setlt or setgt instruction. Since the border cases have
2495 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
2496 //
2497 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLE)
2498 return BinaryOperator::createSetLT(Op0, AddOne(CI));
2499 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGE)
2500 return BinaryOperator::createSetGT(Op0, SubOne(CI));
2501
Chris Lattnere1e10e12004-05-25 06:32:08 +00002502 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002503 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
2504 case Instruction::And:
2505 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
2506 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
2507 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
2508 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
2509 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
2510 // access.
2511 ShiftInst *Shift = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
2512 ConstantUInt *ShAmt;
2513 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
2514 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
2515 const Type *Ty = LHSI->getType();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002516
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002517 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
2518 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
2519 // rights, as they sign-extend.
2520 if (ShAmt) {
2521 bool CanFold = Shift->getOpcode() != Instruction::Shr ||
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00002522 Shift->getType()->isUnsigned();
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002523 if (!CanFold) {
2524 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
2525 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
Chris Lattnerc53cb9d2005-06-17 01:29:28 +00002526 int ShAmtVal = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-ShAmt->getValue();
2527 if (ShAmtVal < 0) ShAmtVal = 0; // Out of range shift.
2528
2529 Constant *OShAmt = ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, ShAmtVal);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002530 Constant *ShVal =
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002531 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Ty), OShAmt);
2532 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(ShVal, AndCST)->isNullValue())
2533 CanFold = true;
2534 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002535
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002536 if (CanFold) {
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00002537 Constant *NewCst;
2538 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2539 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getUShr(CI, ShAmt);
2540 else
2541 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002542
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002543 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
2544 // compared.
2545 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != CI){
2546 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
2547 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
2548 // result is always true or false now.
2549 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ)
2550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2551 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE)
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
2553 } else {
2554 I.setOperand(1, NewCst);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00002555 Constant *NewAndCST;
2556 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2557 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getUShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
2558 else
2559 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
2560 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002561 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
2562 WorkList.push_back(Shift); // Shift is dead.
2563 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2564 return &I;
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00002565 }
2566 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002567 }
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002568 }
2569 break;
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002570
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002571 case Instruction::Shl: // (setcc (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
2572 if (ConstantUInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
2573 switch (I.getOpcode()) {
2574 default: break;
2575 case Instruction::SetEQ:
2576 case Instruction::SetNE: {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00002577 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2578
2579 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
2580 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
2581 // simplified.
2582 if (ShAmt->getValue() >= TypeBits)
2583 break;
2584
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002585 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
2586 // comparison cannot succeed.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002587 Constant *Comp =
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002588 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getShr(CI, ShAmt), ShAmt);
2589 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
2590 bool IsSetNE = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE;
2591 Constant *Cst = ConstantBool::get(IsSetNE);
2592 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
2593 }
2594
2595 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
2596 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00002597 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getValue();
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002598 uint64_t Val = (1ULL << (TypeBits-ShAmtVal))-1;
2599
2600 Constant *Mask;
2601 if (CI->getType()->isUnsigned()) {
2602 Mask = ConstantUInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
2603 } else if (ShAmtVal != 0) {
2604 Mask = ConstantSInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
2605 } else {
2606 Mask = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI->getType());
2607 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002608
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002609 Instruction *AndI =
2610 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
2611 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
2612 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
2613 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), And,
2614 ConstantExpr::getUShr(CI, ShAmt));
2615 }
2616 }
2617 }
2618 }
2619 break;
2620
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002621 case Instruction::Shr: // (setcc (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002622 if (ConstantUInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002623 switch (I.getOpcode()) {
2624 default: break;
2625 case Instruction::SetEQ:
2626 case Instruction::SetNE: {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00002627
2628 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
2629 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
2630 // simplified.
Chris Lattner104002b2005-06-16 01:52:07 +00002631 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00002632 if (ShAmt->getValue() >= TypeBits)
2633 break;
2634
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002635 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
2636 // comparison cannot succeed.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002637 Constant *Comp =
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002638 ConstantExpr::getShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt), ShAmt);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002639
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002640 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
2641 bool IsSetNE = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE;
2642 Constant *Cst = ConstantBool::get(IsSetNE);
2643 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
2644 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002645
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002646 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || CI->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00002647 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getValue();
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00002648
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002649 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
2650 uint64_t Val = ~0ULL; // All ones.
2651 Val <<= ShAmtVal; // Shift over to the right spot.
2652
2653 Constant *Mask;
2654 if (CI->getType()->isUnsigned()) {
Chris Lattner2f1457f2005-04-24 17:46:05 +00002655 Val &= ~0ULL >> (64-TypeBits);
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002656 Mask = ConstantUInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
2657 } else {
2658 Mask = ConstantSInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
2659 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002660
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00002661 Instruction *AndI =
2662 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
2663 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
2664 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
2665 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), And,
2666 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt));
2667 }
2668 break;
2669 }
2670 }
2671 }
2672 break;
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002673
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002674 case Instruction::Div:
2675 // Fold: (div X, C1) op C2 -> range check
2676 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
2677 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
2678 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
2679 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
2680 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
2681 bool LoOverflow = false, HiOverflow = 0;
2682 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
2683
2684 ConstantInt *Prod;
2685 bool ProdOV = MulWithOverflow(Prod, CI, DivRHS);
2686
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00002687 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
2688
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002689 if (DivRHS->isNullValue()) { // Don't hack on divide by zeros.
2690 } else if (LHSI->getType()->isUnsigned()) { // udiv
2691 LoBound = Prod;
2692 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
2693 HiOverflow = ProdOV || AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS);
2694 } else if (isPositive(DivRHS)) { // Divisor is > 0.
2695 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / pos) op 0
2696 // Can't overflow.
2697 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
2698 HiBound = DivRHS;
2699 } else if (isPositive(CI)) { // (X / pos) op pos
2700 LoBound = Prod;
2701 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
2702 HiOverflow = ProdOV || AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS);
2703 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
2704 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
2705 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
2706 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH));
2707 HiBound = Prod;
2708 HiOverflow = ProdOV;
2709 }
2710 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
2711 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / neg) op 0
2712 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
2713 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner73bcba52005-06-17 02:05:55 +00002714 if (HiBound == DivRHS)
2715 LoBound = 0; // - INTMIN = INTMIN
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002716 } else if (isPositive(CI)) { // (X / neg) op pos
2717 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
2718 if (!LoOverflow)
2719 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS));
2720 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
2721 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
2722 LoBound = Prod;
2723 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
2724 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(Prod, DivRHS));
2725 }
Chris Lattner0b41e862004-10-08 19:15:44 +00002726
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00002727 // Dividing by a negate swaps the condition.
2728 Opcode = SetCondInst::getSwappedCondition(Opcode);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002729 }
2730
2731 if (LoBound) {
2732 Value *X = LHSI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00002733 switch (Opcode) {
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00002734 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled setcc opcode!");
2735 case Instruction::SetEQ:
2736 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
2737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2738 else if (HiOverflow)
2739 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGE, X, LoBound);
2740 else if (LoOverflow)
2741 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, X, HiBound);
2742 else
2743 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, true, I);
2744 case Instruction::SetNE:
2745 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
2746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::True);
2747 else if (HiOverflow)
2748 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, X, LoBound);
2749 else if (LoOverflow)
2750 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGE, X, HiBound);
2751 else
2752 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, false, I);
2753 case Instruction::SetLT:
2754 if (LoOverflow)
2755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2756 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetLT, X, LoBound);
2757 case Instruction::SetGT:
2758 if (HiOverflow)
2759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::False);
2760 return new SetCondInst(Instruction::SetGE, X, HiBound);
2761 }
2762 }
2763 }
2764 break;
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00002765 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002766
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002767 // Simplify seteq and setne instructions...
2768 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ ||
2769 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE) {
2770 bool isSetNE = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE;
2771
Chris Lattnercfbce7c2003-07-23 17:26:36 +00002772 // If the first operand is (and|or|xor) with a constant, and the second
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002773 // operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002774 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2775 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner23b47b62004-07-06 07:38:18 +00002776 case Instruction::Rem:
2777 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
2778 if (CI->isNullValue() && isa<ConstantSInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&
2779 BO->hasOneUse() &&
2780 cast<ConstantSInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue() > 1)
2781 if (unsigned L2 =
2782 Log2(cast<ConstantSInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue())) {
2783 const Type *UTy = BO->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
2784 Value *NewX = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(BO->getOperand(0),
2785 UTy, "tmp"), I);
2786 Constant *RHSCst = ConstantUInt::get(UTy, 1ULL << L2);
2787 Value *NewRem =InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createRem(NewX,
2788 RHSCst, BO->getName()), I);
2789 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), NewRem,
2790 Constant::getNullValue(UTy));
2791 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002792 break;
Chris Lattner23b47b62004-07-06 07:38:18 +00002793
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002794 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00002795 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
2796 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb121ae12004-09-21 21:35:23 +00002797 if (BO->hasOneUse())
2798 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), BO->getOperand(0),
2799 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00002800 } else if (CI->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002801 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
2802 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
2803 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002804
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002805 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
2806 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), BOp0, NegVal);
2807 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
2808 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002809 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002810 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1, BO->getName());
2811 BO->setName("");
2812 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, I);
2813 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), BOp0, Neg);
2814 }
2815 }
2816 break;
2817 case Instruction::Xor:
2818 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
2819 // the explicit xor.
2820 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
2821 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002822 ConstantExpr::getXor(CI, BOC));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002823
2824 // FALLTHROUGH
2825 case Instruction::Sub:
2826 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
2827 if (CI->isNullValue())
2828 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), BO->getOperand(0),
2829 BO->getOperand(1));
2830 break;
2831
2832 case Instruction::Or:
2833 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
2834 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002835 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00002836 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(CI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002837 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::get(isSetNE));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002839 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002840 break;
2841
2842 case Instruction::And:
2843 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002844 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
2845 // comparison can never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00002846 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI,
2847 ConstantExpr::getNot(BOC))->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantBool::get(isSetNE));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002849
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002850 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
Chris Lattneree59d4b2004-06-10 02:33:20 +00002851 if (CI == BOC && isOneBitSet(CI))
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002852 return new SetCondInst(isSetNE ? Instruction::SetEQ :
2853 Instruction::SetNE, Op0,
2854 Constant::getNullValue(CI->getType()));
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002855
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002856 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x < 0, converting X
2857 // to be a signed value as appropriate.
2858 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
2859 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
2860 // If 'X' is not signed, insert a cast now...
2861 if (!BOC->getType()->isSigned()) {
Chris Lattner97bfcea2004-06-17 18:16:02 +00002862 const Type *DestTy = BOC->getType()->getSignedVersion();
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002863 X = InsertCastBefore(X, DestTy, I);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002864 }
2865 return new SetCondInst(isSetNE ? Instruction::SetLT :
2866 Instruction::SetGE, X,
2867 Constant::getNullValue(X->getType()));
2868 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002869
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002870 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002871 if (CI->isNullValue() && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
2872 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002873 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002874
2875 // If 'X' is signed, insert a cast now.
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002876 if (NegX->getType()->isSigned()) {
2877 const Type *DestTy = NegX->getType()->getUnsignedVersion();
2878 X = InsertCastBefore(X, DestTy, I);
2879 NegX = ConstantExpr::getCast(NegX, DestTy);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002880 }
2881
2882 return new SetCondInst(isSetNE ? Instruction::SetGE :
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00002883 Instruction::SetLT, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002884 }
2885
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00002886 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00002887 default: break;
2888 }
2889 }
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002890 } else { // Not a SetEQ/SetNE
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002891 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002892 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
2893 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
2894 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002895 unsigned SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002896 if (SrcTy != Cast->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002897 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002898 assert((SrcTy->isSigned() ^ Cast->getType()->isSigned()) &&
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002899 "Source and destination signednesses should differ!");
2900 if (Cast->getType()->isSigned()) {
2901 // If this is a signed comparison, check for comparisons in the
2902 // vicinity of zero.
2903 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT && CI->isNullValue())
2904 // X < 0 => x > 127
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002905 return BinaryOperator::createSetGT(CastOp,
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002906 ConstantUInt::get(SrcTy, (1ULL << (SrcTySize-1))-1));
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002907 else if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGT &&
2908 cast<ConstantSInt>(CI)->getValue() == -1)
2909 // X > -1 => x < 128
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002910 return BinaryOperator::createSetLT(CastOp,
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002911 ConstantUInt::get(SrcTy, 1ULL << (SrcTySize-1)));
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002912 } else {
2913 ConstantUInt *CUI = cast<ConstantUInt>(CI);
2914 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002915 CUI->getValue() == 1ULL << (SrcTySize-1))
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002916 // X < 128 => X > -1
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002917 return BinaryOperator::createSetGT(CastOp,
2918 ConstantSInt::get(SrcTy, -1));
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002919 else if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetGT &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002920 CUI->getValue() == (1ULL << (SrcTySize-1))-1)
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002921 // X > 127 => X < 0
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002922 return BinaryOperator::createSetLT(CastOp,
2923 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00002924 }
2925 }
2926 }
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00002927 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002928 }
2929
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00002930 // Handle setcc with constant RHS's that can be integer, FP or pointer.
2931 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
2932 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2933 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00002934 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
2935 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
2936 // Transform setcc GEP P, int 0, int 0, int 0, null -> setcc P, null
2937 bool isAllZeros = true;
2938 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
2939 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
2940 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
2941 isAllZeros = false;
2942 break;
2943 }
2944 if (isAllZeros)
2945 return new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
2946 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
2947 }
2948 break;
2949
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00002950 case Instruction::PHI:
2951 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2952 return NV;
2953 break;
2954 case Instruction::Select:
2955 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
2956 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
2957 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
2958 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
2959 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
2960 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
2961 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
2962 Op1 = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C, RHSC);
2963 // Insert a new SetCC of the other select operand.
2964 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(),
2965 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
2966 I.getName()), I);
2967 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
2968 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
2969 Op2 = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C, RHSC);
2970 // Insert a new SetCC of the other select operand.
2971 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new SetCondInst(I.getOpcode(),
2972 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
2973 I.getName()), I);
2974 }
2975 }
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00002976
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00002977 if (Op1)
2978 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
2979 break;
2980 }
2981 }
2982
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00002983 // If we can optimize a 'setcc GEP, P' or 'setcc P, GEP', do so now.
2984 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
2985 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPSetCC(GEP, Op1, I.getOpcode(), I))
2986 return NI;
2987 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
2988 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPSetCC(GEP, Op0,
2989 SetCondInst::getSwappedCondition(I.getOpcode()), I))
2990 return NI;
2991
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00002992 // Test to see if the operands of the setcc are casted versions of other
2993 // values. If the cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so now.
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00002994 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
2995 Value *CastOp0 = CI->getOperand(0);
2996 if (CastOp0->getType()->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(CI->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00002997 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1)) &&
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00002998 (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ ||
2999 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE)) {
3000 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
3001 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00003002 Op0 = CastOp0;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003003
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00003004 // If operand #1 is a cast instruction, see if we can eliminate it as
3005 // well.
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00003006 if (CastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3007 if (CI2->getOperand(0)->getType()->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00003008 Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00003009 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003010
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00003011 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
3012 if (Op1->getType() != Op0->getType())
3013 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
3014 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
3015 } else {
3016 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the setcc
3017 Op1 = new CastInst(Op1, Op0->getType(), Op1->getName());
3018 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Op1), I);
3019 }
3020 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0, Op1);
3021 }
3022
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00003023 // Handle the special case of: setcc (cast bool to X), <cst>
3024 // This comes up when you have code like
3025 // int X = A < B;
3026 // if (X) ...
3027 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003028 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
3029 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
3030 if (Instruction *R = visitSetCondInstWithCastAndCast(I))
3031 return R;
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00003032 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003033 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003034}
3035
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003036// visitSetCondInstWithCastAndCast - Handle setcond (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
3037// We only handle extending casts so far.
3038//
3039Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSetCondInstWithCastAndCast(SetCondInst &SCI) {
3040 Value *LHSCIOp = cast<CastInst>(SCI.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
3041 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
3042 const Type *DestTy = SCI.getOperand(0)->getType();
3043 Value *RHSCIOp;
3044
3045 if (!DestTy->isIntegral() || !SrcTy->isIntegral())
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00003046 return 0;
3047
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003048 unsigned SrcBits = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
3049 unsigned DestBits = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
3050 if (SrcBits >= DestBits) return 0; // Only handle extending cast.
3051
3052 // Is this a sign or zero extension?
3053 bool isSignSrc = SrcTy->isSigned();
3054 bool isSignDest = DestTy->isSigned();
3055
3056 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SCI.getOperand(1))) {
3057 // Not an extension from the same type?
3058 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
3059 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType()) return 0;
3060 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SCI.getOperand(1))) {
3061 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
3062 // reextended to DestTy.
3063 Constant *Res = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI, SrcTy);
3064
3065 if (ConstantExpr::getCast(Res, DestTy) == CI) {
3066 RHSCIOp = Res;
3067 } else {
3068 // If the value cannot be represented in the shorter type, we cannot emit
3069 // a simple comparison.
3070 if (SCI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ)
3071 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SCI, ConstantBool::False);
3072 if (SCI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE)
3073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SCI, ConstantBool::True);
3074
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003075 // Evaluate the comparison for LT.
3076 Value *Result;
3077 if (DestTy->isSigned()) {
3078 // We're performing a signed comparison.
3079 if (isSignSrc) {
3080 // Signed extend and signed comparison.
3081 if (cast<ConstantSInt>(CI)->getValue() < 0) // X < (small) --> false
3082 Result = ConstantBool::False;
3083 else
3084 Result = ConstantBool::True; // X < (large) --> true
3085 } else {
3086 // Unsigned extend and signed comparison.
3087 if (cast<ConstantSInt>(CI)->getValue() < 0)
3088 Result = ConstantBool::False;
3089 else
3090 Result = ConstantBool::True;
3091 }
3092 } else {
3093 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
3094 if (!isSignSrc) {
3095 // Unsigned extend & compare -> always true.
3096 Result = ConstantBool::True;
3097 } else {
3098 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
3099 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
3100 Constant *NegOne = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
3101 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSetGT(LHSCIOp,
3102 NegOne, SCI.getName()), SCI);
3103 }
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00003104 }
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00003105
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00003106 // Finally, return the value computed.
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003107 if (SCI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SetLT) {
3108 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SCI, Result);
3109 } else {
3110 assert(SCI.getOpcode()==Instruction::SetGT &&"SetCC should be folded!");
3111 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
3112 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SCI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
3113 else
3114 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
3115 }
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00003116 }
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003117 } else {
3118 return 0;
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00003119 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003120
Chris Lattner252a8452005-06-16 03:00:08 +00003121 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003122 return BinaryOperator::create(SCI.getOpcode(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
3123}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003124
Chris Lattnere8d6c602003-03-10 19:16:08 +00003125Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShiftInst(ShiftInst &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003126 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == Type::UByteTy);
3127 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003128 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003129
3130 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
3131 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
3132 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Type::UByteTy) ||
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003133 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
3134 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003135
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003136 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef >>s X -> undef
3137 if (!isLeftShift && I.getType()->isSigned())
Chris Lattner67f05452004-10-16 23:28:04 +00003138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003139 else // undef << X -> 0 AND undef >>u X -> 0
3140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3141 }
3142 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner18aa4d82005-07-20 18:49:28 +00003143 if (isLeftShift || I.getType()->isUnsigned())// X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3145 else
3146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X >>s undef -> X
3147 }
3148
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003149 // shr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
3150 if (!isLeftShift)
3151 if (ConstantSInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantSInt>(Op0))
3152 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
3153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
3154
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003155 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3156 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
3157 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003158 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003159 return R;
3160
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00003161 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
3162 if (!isLeftShift && I.getType()->isSigned()) {
3163 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, ConstantInt::getMinValue(I.getType()))) {
3164 Value *V = InsertCastBefore(Op0, I.getType()->getUnsignedVersion(), I);
3165 V = InsertNewInstBefore(new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, V, Op1,
3166 I.getName()), I);
3167 return new CastInst(V, I.getType());
3168 }
3169 }
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00003170
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003171 if (ConstantUInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003172 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
3173 // of a signed value.
3174 //
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003175 unsigned TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerf5ce2542004-02-23 20:30:06 +00003176 if (CUI->getValue() >= TypeBits) {
3177 if (!Op0->getType()->isSigned() || isLeftShift)
3178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
3179 else {
3180 I.setOperand(1, ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, TypeBits-1));
3181 return &I;
3182 }
3183 }
Chris Lattner55f3d942002-09-10 23:04:09 +00003184
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00003185 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
3186 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3187 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
3188 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003189 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
3190 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, CUI));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003191
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003192 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3193 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003194 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003195 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003196 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3197 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3198 return NV;
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00003199
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003200 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
3201 // If this is a SHL of a sign-extending cast, see if we can turn the input
3202 // into a zero extending cast (a simple strength reduction).
3203 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
3204 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
3205 if (isLeftShift && SrcTy->isInteger() && SrcTy->isSigned() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003206 SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <
3207 CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003208 // We can change it to a zero extension if we are shifting out all of
3209 // the sign extended bits. To check this, form a mask of all of the
3210 // sign extend bits, then shift them left and see if we have anything
3211 // left.
3212 Constant *Mask = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy); // 1111
3213 Mask = ConstantExpr::getZeroExtend(Mask, CI->getType()); // 00001111
3214 Mask = ConstantExpr::getNot(Mask); // 1's in the sign bits: 11110000
3215 if (ConstantExpr::getShl(Mask, CUI)->isNullValue()) {
3216 // If the shift is nuking all of the sign bits, change this to a
3217 // zero extension cast. To do this, cast the cast input to
3218 // unsigned, then to the requested size.
3219 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
3220 Instruction *NC =
3221 new CastInst(CastOp, CastOp->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(),
3222 CI->getName()+".uns");
3223 NC = InsertNewInstBefore(NC, I);
3224 // Finally, insert a replacement for CI.
3225 NC = new CastInst(NC, CI->getType(), CI->getName());
3226 CI->setName("");
3227 NC = InsertNewInstBefore(NC, I);
3228 WorkList.push_back(CI); // Delete CI later.
3229 I.setOperand(0, NC);
3230 return &I; // The SHL operand was modified.
3231 }
3232 }
3233 }
3234
3235 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
3236 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003237 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3238 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
3239 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
3240 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
3241
3242 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
3243 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner44bd3922004-10-08 03:46:20 +00003244 case Instruction::Add:
3245 isValid = isLeftShift;
3246 break;
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003247 case Instruction::Or:
3248 case Instruction::Xor:
3249 highBitSet = false;
3250 break;
3251 case Instruction::And:
3252 highBitSet = true;
3253 break;
3254 }
3255
3256 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
3257 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
3258 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
3259 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
3260 // operation.
3261 //
3262 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && !I.getType()->isUnsigned()) {
3263 uint64_t Val = Op0C->getRawValue();
3264 isValid = ((Val & (1 << (TypeBits-1))) != 0) == highBitSet;
3265 }
3266
3267 if (isValid) {
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003268 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, CUI);
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003269
3270 Instruction *NewShift =
3271 new ShiftInst(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), CUI,
3272 Op0BO->getName());
3273 Op0BO->setName("");
3274 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
3275
3276 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
3277 NewRHS);
3278 }
3279 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003280 }
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003281
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003282 // If this is a shift of a shift, see if we can fold the two together...
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003283 if (ShiftInst *Op0SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerab780df2003-07-24 18:38:56 +00003284 if (ConstantUInt *ShiftAmt1C =
3285 dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(Op0SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00003286 unsigned ShiftAmt1 = (unsigned)ShiftAmt1C->getValue();
3287 unsigned ShiftAmt2 = (unsigned)CUI->getValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003288
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003289 // Check for (A << c1) << c2 and (A >> c1) >> c2
3290 if (I.getOpcode() == Op0SI->getOpcode()) {
3291 unsigned Amt = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift...
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003292 if (Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < Amt)
3293 Amt = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003294 return new ShiftInst(I.getOpcode(), Op0SI->getOperand(0),
3295 ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, Amt));
3296 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003297
Chris Lattnerab780df2003-07-24 18:38:56 +00003298 // Check for (A << c1) >> c2 or visaversa. If we are dealing with
3299 // signed types, we can only support the (A >> c1) << c2 configuration,
3300 // because it can not turn an arbitrary bit of A into a sign bit.
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003301 if (I.getType()->isUnsigned() || isLeftShift) {
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003302 // Calculate bitmask for what gets shifted off the edge...
3303 Constant *C = ConstantIntegral::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003304 if (isLeftShift)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003305 C = ConstantExpr::getShl(C, ShiftAmt1C);
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00003306 else
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003307 C = ConstantExpr::getShr(C, ShiftAmt1C);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003308
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003309 Instruction *Mask =
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003310 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0SI->getOperand(0), C,
3311 Op0SI->getOperand(0)->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003312 InsertNewInstBefore(Mask, I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003313
Chris Lattner3204d4e2003-07-24 17:52:58 +00003314 // Figure out what flavor of shift we should use...
3315 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2)
3316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Mask); // (A << c) >> c === A & c2
3317 else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
3318 return new ShiftInst(I.getOpcode(), Mask,
3319 ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1));
3320 } else {
3321 return new ShiftInst(Op0SI->getOpcode(), Mask,
3322 ConstantUInt::get(Type::UByteTy, ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2));
3323 }
3324 }
3325 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003326 }
Chris Lattner2e0fb392002-10-08 16:16:40 +00003327
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003328 return 0;
3329}
3330
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003331enum CastType {
3332 Noop = 0,
3333 Truncate = 1,
3334 Signext = 2,
3335 Zeroext = 3
3336};
3337
3338/// getCastType - In the future, we will split the cast instruction into these
3339/// various types. Until then, we have to do the analysis here.
3340static CastType getCastType(const Type *Src, const Type *Dest) {
3341 assert(Src->isIntegral() && Dest->isIntegral() &&
3342 "Only works on integral types!");
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003343 unsigned SrcSize = Src->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
3344 unsigned DestSize = Dest->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003345
3346 if (SrcSize == DestSize) return Noop;
3347 if (SrcSize > DestSize) return Truncate;
3348 if (Src->isSigned()) return Signext;
3349 return Zeroext;
3350}
3351
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003352
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003353// isEliminableCastOfCast - Return true if it is valid to eliminate the CI
3354// instruction.
3355//
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003356static inline bool isEliminableCastOfCast(const Type *SrcTy, const Type *MidTy,
Chris Lattner11ffd592004-07-20 05:21:00 +00003357 const Type *DstTy, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003358
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003359 // It is legal to eliminate the instruction if casting A->B->A if the sizes
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003360 // are identical and the bits don't get reinterpreted (for example
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00003361 // int->float->int would not be allowed).
Misha Brukmane5838c42003-05-20 18:45:36 +00003362 if (SrcTy == DstTy && SrcTy->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(MidTy))
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003363 return true;
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003364
Chris Lattner4fbad962004-07-21 04:27:24 +00003365 // If we are casting between pointer and integer types, treat pointers as
3366 // integers of the appropriate size for the code below.
3367 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) SrcTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
3368 if (isa<PointerType>(MidTy)) MidTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
3369 if (isa<PointerType>(DstTy)) DstTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattner11ffd592004-07-20 05:21:00 +00003370
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003371 // Allow free casting and conversion of sizes as long as the sign doesn't
3372 // change...
Chris Lattnerb0b412e2002-09-03 01:08:28 +00003373 if (SrcTy->isIntegral() && MidTy->isIntegral() && DstTy->isIntegral()) {
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003374 CastType FirstCast = getCastType(SrcTy, MidTy);
3375 CastType SecondCast = getCastType(MidTy, DstTy);
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003376
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003377 // Capture the effect of these two casts. If the result is a legal cast,
3378 // the CastType is stored here, otherwise a special code is used.
3379 static const unsigned CastResult[] = {
3380 // First cast is noop
3381 0, 1, 2, 3,
3382 // First cast is a truncate
3383 1, 1, 4, 4, // trunc->extend is not safe to eliminate
3384 // First cast is a sign ext
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00003385 2, 5, 2, 4, // signext->zeroext never ok
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003386 // First cast is a zero ext
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00003387 3, 5, 3, 3,
Chris Lattner4e2dbc62004-07-20 00:59:32 +00003388 };
3389
3390 unsigned Result = CastResult[FirstCast*4+SecondCast];
3391 switch (Result) {
3392 default: assert(0 && "Illegal table value!");
3393 case 0:
3394 case 1:
3395 case 2:
3396 case 3:
3397 // FIXME: in the future, when LLVM has explicit sign/zeroextends and
3398 // truncates, we could eliminate more casts.
3399 return (unsigned)getCastType(SrcTy, DstTy) == Result;
3400 case 4:
3401 return false; // Not possible to eliminate this here.
3402 case 5:
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00003403 // Sign or zero extend followed by truncate is always ok if the result
3404 // is a truncate or noop.
3405 CastType ResultCast = getCastType(SrcTy, DstTy);
3406 if (ResultCast == Noop || ResultCast == Truncate)
3407 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003408 // Otherwise we are still growing the value, we are only safe if the
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00003409 // result will match the sign/zeroextendness of the result.
3410 return ResultCast == FirstCast;
Chris Lattner3732aca2002-08-15 16:15:25 +00003411 }
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003412 }
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003413 return false;
3414}
3415
Chris Lattner11ffd592004-07-20 05:21:00 +00003416static bool ValueRequiresCast(const Value *V, const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003417 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
3418 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Chris Lattner11ffd592004-07-20 05:21:00 +00003419 if (isEliminableCastOfCast(CI->getOperand(0)->getType(), CI->getType(), Ty,
3420 TD))
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003421 return false;
3422 return true;
3423}
3424
3425/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
3426/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
3427/// casts that are known to not do anything...
3428///
3429Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
3430 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
3431 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
3432 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
3433 return ConstantExpr::getCast(C, DestTy);
3434
3435 CastInst *CI = new CastInst(V, DestTy, V->getName());
3436 InsertNewInstBefore(CI, *InsertBefore);
3437 return CI;
3438}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003439
3440// CastInst simplification
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003441//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003442Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCastInst(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00003443 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
3444
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003445 // If the user is casting a value to the same type, eliminate this cast
3446 // instruction...
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00003447 if (CI.getType() == Src->getType())
3448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003449
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003450 if (isa<UndefValue>(Src)) // cast undef -> undef
3451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(CI.getType()));
3452
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003453 // If casting the result of another cast instruction, try to eliminate this
3454 // one!
3455 //
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003456 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
3457 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
3458 if (isEliminableCastOfCast(A->getType(), CSrc->getType(),
3459 CI.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003460 // This instruction now refers directly to the cast's src operand. This
3461 // has a good chance of making CSrc dead.
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003462 CI.setOperand(0, CSrc->getOperand(0));
3463 return &CI;
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00003464 }
3465
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003466 // If this is an A->B->A cast, and we are dealing with integral types, try
3467 // to convert this into a logical 'and' instruction.
3468 //
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003469 if (A->getType()->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattnerb0b412e2002-09-03 01:08:28 +00003470 CI.getType()->isInteger() && CSrc->getType()->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003471 CSrc->getType()->isUnsigned() && // B->A cast must zero extend
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003472 CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <
3473 CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()&&
3474 A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
3475 CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003476 assert(CSrc->getType() != Type::ULongTy &&
3477 "Cannot have type bigger than ulong!");
Chris Lattner2f1457f2005-04-24 17:46:05 +00003478 uint64_t AndValue = ~0ULL>>(64-CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003479 Constant *AndOp = ConstantUInt::get(A->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(),
3480 AndValue);
3481 AndOp = ConstantExpr::getCast(AndOp, A->getType());
3482 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndOp);
3483 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
3484 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
3485 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
3486 And = new CastInst(And, CI.getType());
3487 }
3488 return And;
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00003489 }
3490 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003491
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00003492 // If this is a cast to bool, turn it into the appropriate setne instruction.
3493 if (CI.getType() == Type::BoolTy)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003494 return BinaryOperator::createSetNE(CI.getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00003495 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getOperand(0)->getType()));
3496
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00003497 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
3498 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
3499 //
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00003500 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00003501 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
3502 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
3503 if (!isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i)) ||
3504 !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
3505 AllZeroOperands = false;
3506 break;
3507 }
3508 if (AllZeroOperands) {
3509 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
3510 return &CI;
3511 }
3512 }
3513
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00003514 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
3515 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
3516 //
3517 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
Chris Lattnerd4d987d2003-11-02 06:54:48 +00003518 if (AI->hasOneUse() && !AI->isArrayAllocation())
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00003519 if (const PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())) {
3520 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to...
3521 const Type *AllocElTy = AI->getAllocatedType();
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00003522 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattner9eb9ccd2004-07-06 19:28:42 +00003523 if (AllocElTy->isSized() && CastElTy->isSized()) {
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00003524 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
3525 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner7c94d112003-11-05 17:31:36 +00003526
Chris Lattner9eb9ccd2004-07-06 19:28:42 +00003527 // If the allocation is for an even multiple of the cast type size
3528 if (CastElTySize && (AllocElTySize % CastElTySize == 0)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003529 Value *Amt = ConstantUInt::get(Type::UIntTy,
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00003530 AllocElTySize/CastElTySize);
Chris Lattner9eb9ccd2004-07-06 19:28:42 +00003531 std::string Name = AI->getName(); AI->setName("");
3532 AllocationInst *New;
3533 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
3534 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, Name);
3535 else
3536 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, Name);
3537 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *AI);
3538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
3539 }
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00003540 }
3541 }
3542
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003543 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
3544 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
3545 return NV;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003546 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
3547 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
3548 return NV;
3549
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003550 // If the source value is an instruction with only this use, we can attempt to
3551 // propagate the cast into the instruction. Also, only handle integral types
3552 // for now.
3553 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src))
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003554 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && Src->getType()->isIntegral() &&
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003555 CI.getType()->isInteger()) { // Don't mess with casts to bool here
3556 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00003557 unsigned SrcBitSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
3558 unsigned DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003559
3560 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
3561 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
3562
3563 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
3564 case Instruction::Add:
3565 case Instruction::Mul:
3566 case Instruction::And:
3567 case Instruction::Or:
3568 case Instruction::Xor:
3569 // If we are discarding information, or just changing the sign, rewrite.
3570 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
3571 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow two
3572 // casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could only be
3573 // converting signedness, which is a noop.
Chris Lattner11ffd592004-07-20 05:21:00 +00003574 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize || !ValueRequiresCast(Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
3575 !ValueRequiresCast(Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003576 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
3577 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
3578 return BinaryOperator::create(cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)
3579 ->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
3580 }
3581 }
Chris Lattner72086162005-05-06 02:07:39 +00003582
3583 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
3584 if (SrcBitSize == 1 && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
3585 Op1 == ConstantBool::True &&
3586 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<SetCondInst>(Op0))) {
3587 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Op0, DestTy, &CI);
3588 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New,
3589 ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
3590 }
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003591 break;
3592 case Instruction::Shl:
3593 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow changing
3594 // the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a constant. We
3595 // mush not change variable sized shifts to a smaller size, because it
3596 // is undefined to shift more bits out than exist in the value.
3597 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
3598 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
3599 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
3600 return new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shl, Op0c, Op1);
3601 }
3602 break;
Chris Lattner87380412005-05-06 04:18:52 +00003603 case Instruction::Shr:
3604 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
3605 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
3606 // simplifications.
3607 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && Src->getType()->isSigned() &&
3608 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3609 unsigned ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantUInt>(Op1)->getValue();
3610 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
3611 // Convert to unsigned.
3612 Value *N1 = InsertOperandCastBefore(Op0,
3613 Op0->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(), &CI);
3614 // Insert the new shift, which is now unsigned.
3615 N1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, N1,
3616 Op1, Src->getName()), CI);
3617 return new CastInst(N1, CI.getType());
3618 }
3619 }
3620 break;
3621
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00003622 case Instruction::SetNE:
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00003623 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00003624 if (Op1C->getRawValue() == 0) {
3625 // If the input only has the low bit set, simplify directly.
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00003626 Constant *Not1 =
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00003627 ConstantExpr::getNot(ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00003628 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X if X&~1 == 0
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00003629 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, cast<ConstantIntegral>(Not1))) {
3630 if (CI.getType() == Op0->getType())
3631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op0);
3632 else
3633 return new CastInst(Op0, CI.getType());
3634 }
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00003635
3636 // If the input is an and with a single bit, shift then simplify.
3637 ConstantInt *AndRHS;
3638 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(AndRHS))))
3639 if (AndRHS->getRawValue() &&
3640 (AndRHS->getRawValue() & (AndRHS->getRawValue()-1)) == 0) {
3641 unsigned ShiftAmt = Log2(AndRHS->getRawValue());
3642 // Perform an unsigned shr by shiftamt. Convert input to
3643 // unsigned if it is signed.
3644 Value *In = Op0;
3645 if (In->getType()->isSigned())
3646 In = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(In,
3647 In->getType()->getUnsignedVersion(), In->getName()),CI);
3648 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
3649 In = InsertNewInstBefore(new ShiftInst(Instruction::Shr, In,
3650 ConstantInt::get(Type::UByteTy, ShiftAmt),
3651 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00003652 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
3653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
3654 else
3655 return new CastInst(In, CI.getType());
3656 }
3657 }
3658 }
3659 break;
3660 case Instruction::SetEQ:
3661 // We if we are just checking for a seteq of a single bit and casting it
3662 // to an integer. If so, shift the bit to the appropriate place then
3663 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
3664 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3665 // Is Op1C a power of two or zero?
3666 if ((Op1C->getRawValue() & Op1C->getRawValue()-1) == 0) {
3667 // cast (X == 1) to int -> X iff X has only the low bit set.
3668 if (Op1C->getRawValue() == 1) {
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00003669 Constant *Not1 =
Chris Lattner4c2d3782005-05-06 01:53:19 +00003670 ConstantExpr::getNot(ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), 1));
3671 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, cast<ConstantIntegral>(Not1))) {
3672 if (CI.getType() == Op0->getType())
3673 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op0);
3674 else
3675 return new CastInst(Op0, CI.getType());
3676 }
3677 }
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00003678 }
3679 }
3680 break;
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00003681 }
3682 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00003683 return 0;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00003684}
3685
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00003686/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
3687/// %C = or %A, %B
3688/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
3689/// into:
3690/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
3691/// %D = or %A, %C
3692///
3693/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
3694/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
3695/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
3696///
3697static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
3698 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
3699 case Instruction::Add:
3700 case Instruction::Mul:
3701 case Instruction::And:
3702 case Instruction::Or:
3703 case Instruction::Xor:
3704 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
3705 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
3706 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
3707 case Instruction::Shr:
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003708 return 1;
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00003709 default:
3710 return 0; // Cannot fold
3711 }
3712}
3713
3714/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
3715/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
3716static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
3717 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
3718 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
3719 case Instruction::Add:
3720 case Instruction::Sub:
3721 case Instruction::Or:
3722 case Instruction::Xor:
3723 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
3724 case Instruction::Shl:
3725 case Instruction::Shr:
3726 return Constant::getNullValue(Type::UByteTy);
3727 case Instruction::And:
3728 return ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
3729 case Instruction::Mul:
3730 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
3731 }
3732}
3733
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00003734/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
3735/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
3736Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
3737 Instruction *FI) {
3738 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
3739 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
3740 // merge.
3741 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Cast) {
3742 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
3743 return 0;
3744 } else {
3745 return 0; // unknown unary op.
3746 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003747
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00003748 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
3749 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
3750 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
3751 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
3752 return new CastInst(NewSI, TI->getType());
3753 }
3754
3755 // Only handle binary operators here.
3756 if (!isa<ShiftInst>(TI) && !isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
3757 return 0;
3758
3759 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
3760 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
3761 bool MatchIsOpZero;
3762 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
3763 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
3764 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
3765 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
3766 MatchIsOpZero = true;
3767 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
3768 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
3769 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
3770 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
3771 MatchIsOpZero = false;
3772 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
3773 return 0;
3774 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
3775 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
3776 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
3777 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
3778 MatchIsOpZero = true;
3779 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
3780 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
3781 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
3782 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
3783 MatchIsOpZero = true;
3784 } else {
3785 return 0;
3786 }
3787
3788 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
3789 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
3790 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
3791 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
3792
3793 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
3794 if (MatchIsOpZero)
3795 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
3796 else
3797 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
3798 } else {
3799 if (MatchIsOpZero)
3800 return new ShiftInst(cast<ShiftInst>(TI)->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
3801 else
3802 return new ShiftInst(cast<ShiftInst>(TI)->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
3803 }
3804}
3805
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00003806Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00003807 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
3808 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
3809 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
3810
3811 // select true, X, Y -> X
3812 // select false, X, Y -> Y
3813 if (ConstantBool *C = dyn_cast<ConstantBool>(CondVal))
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00003814 if (C == ConstantBool::True)
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00003815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00003816 else {
3817 assert(C == ConstantBool::False);
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00003818 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00003819 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00003820
3821 // select C, X, X -> X
3822 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
3823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
3824
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003825 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
3826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
3827 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
3828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
3829 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
3830 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
3831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
3832 else
3833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
3834 }
3835
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00003836 if (SI.getType() == Type::BoolTy)
3837 if (ConstantBool *C = dyn_cast<ConstantBool>(TrueVal)) {
3838 if (C == ConstantBool::True) {
3839 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003840 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00003841 } else {
3842 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
3843 Value *NotCond =
3844 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
3845 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003846 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00003847 }
3848 } else if (ConstantBool *C = dyn_cast<ConstantBool>(FalseVal)) {
3849 if (C == ConstantBool::False) {
3850 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003851 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00003852 } else {
3853 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
3854 Value *NotCond =
3855 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
3856 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003857 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00003858 }
3859 }
3860
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003861 // Selecting between two integer constants?
3862 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
3863 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
3864 // select C, 1, 0 -> cast C to int
3865 if (FalseValC->isNullValue() && TrueValC->getRawValue() == 1) {
3866 return new CastInst(CondVal, SI.getType());
3867 } else if (TrueValC->isNullValue() && FalseValC->getRawValue() == 1) {
3868 // select C, 0, 1 -> cast !C to int
3869 Value *NotCond =
3870 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00003871 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003872 return new CastInst(NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00003873 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003874
3875 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
3876 // have a setcc instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
3877 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
3878 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
3879 if (TrueValC->isNullValue() || FalseValC->isNullValue())
3880 if (Instruction *IC = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI.getCondition()))
3881 if ((IC->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ ||
3882 IC->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE) &&
3883 isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
3884 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
3885 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
3886 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003887 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
3888 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
3889 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003890 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
3891 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
3892 // know whether we have a setne or seteq and whether the true or
3893 // false val is the zero.
3894 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isNullValue();
3895 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE;
3896 Value *V = ICA;
3897 if (ShouldNotVal)
3898 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
3899 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
3900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
3901 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00003902 }
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00003903
3904 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
3905 if (SetCondInst *SCI = dyn_cast<SetCondInst>(CondVal)) {
3906 if (SCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && SCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
3907 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
3908 if (SCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ)
3909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
3910 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
3911 if (SCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE)
3912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
3913 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
3914
3915 } else if (SCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && SCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
3916 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
3917 if (SCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetEQ)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00003918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00003919 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
3920 if (SCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SetNE)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00003921 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00003922 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
3923 }
3924 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003925
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00003926 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
3927 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
3928 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
3929 bool isInverse = false;
3930 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
3931
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00003932 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
3933 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
3934 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
3935 return IV;
3936
3937 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
3938 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00003939 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
3940 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
3941 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
3942 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
3943 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
3944 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
3945 }
3946
3947 if (AddOp) {
3948 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
3949 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
3950 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
3951 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
3952 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
3953 }
3954
3955 if (OtherAddOp) {
3956 // So at this point we know we have:
3957 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, ?)
3958 // We can do the transform profitably if either 'Y' = '?' or '?' is
3959 // a constant.
3960 if (SubOp->getOperand(1) == AddOp ||
3961 isa<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
3962 Value *NegVal;
3963 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
3964 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
3965 } else {
3966 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
3967 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1)), SI);
3968 }
3969
Chris Lattner51726c42005-01-14 17:35:12 +00003970 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00003971 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
3972 if (AddOp != TI)
3973 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
3974 Instruction *NewSel =
3975 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003976
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00003977 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner51726c42005-01-14 17:35:12 +00003978 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00003979 }
3980 }
3981 }
3982 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003983
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00003984 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
3985 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
3986 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
3987 // transformation we are doing here.
3988 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
3989 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
3990 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
3991 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
3992 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
3993 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
3994 OpToFold = 1;
3995 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
3996 OpToFold = 2;
3997 }
3998
3999 if (OpToFold) {
4000 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
4001 std::string Name = TVI->getName(); TVI->setName("");
4002 Instruction *NewSel =
4003 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C,
4004 Name);
4005 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
4006 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
4007 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
4008 else if (ShiftInst *SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(TVI))
4009 return new ShiftInst(SI->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
4010 else {
4011 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
4012 }
4013 }
4014 }
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004015
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00004016 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
4017 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
4018 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
4019 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
4020 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
4021 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
4022 OpToFold = 1;
4023 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
4024 OpToFold = 2;
4025 }
4026
4027 if (OpToFold) {
4028 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
4029 std::string Name = FVI->getName(); FVI->setName("");
4030 Instruction *NewSel =
4031 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold),
4032 Name);
4033 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
4034 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
4035 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
4036 else if (ShiftInst *SI = dyn_cast<ShiftInst>(FVI))
4037 return new ShiftInst(SI->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
4038 else {
4039 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
4040 }
4041 }
4042 }
4043 }
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00004044
4045 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
4046 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
4047 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
4048 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
4049 return &SI;
4050 }
4051
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00004052 return 0;
4053}
4054
4055
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004056// CallInst simplification
4057//
4058Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00004059 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
4060 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00004061 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(&CI)) {
4062 bool Changed = false;
4063
4064 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
4065 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
4066 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
4067
4068 // FIXME: Increase alignment here.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004069
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00004070 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
4071 if (CI->getRawValue() == 1) {
4072 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
4073 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
4074 // alignment is sufficient.
4075 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00004076 }
4077
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00004078 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
4079 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
4080 // into a call to memcpy.
4081 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI))
4082 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
4083 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
4084 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
4085 Function *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction("llvm.memcpy",
4086 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
4087 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
4088 Changed = true;
4089 }
4090
4091 if (Changed) return &CI;
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +00004092 } else if (DbgStopPointInst *SPI = dyn_cast<DbgStopPointInst>(&CI)) {
4093 // If this stoppoint is at the same source location as the previous
4094 // stoppoint in the chain, it is not needed.
4095 if (DbgStopPointInst *PrevSPI =
4096 dyn_cast<DbgStopPointInst>(SPI->getChain()))
4097 if (SPI->getLineNo() == PrevSPI->getLineNo() &&
4098 SPI->getColNo() == PrevSPI->getColNo()) {
4099 SPI->replaceAllUsesWith(PrevSPI);
4100 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
4101 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00004102 }
4103
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00004104 return visitCallSite(&CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004105}
4106
4107// InvokeInst simplification
4108//
4109Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00004110 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004111}
4112
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00004113// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
4114//
4115Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00004116 bool Changed = false;
4117
4118 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
4119 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00004120 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
4121
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00004122 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004123
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00004124 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
4125 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
4126 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
4127 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
4128 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
4129 new StoreInst(ConstantBool::True,
4130 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::BoolTy)), OldCall);
4131 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
4132 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
4133 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
4134 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
4135 return 0;
4136 }
4137
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004138 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
4139 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
4140 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
4141 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
4142 new StoreInst(ConstantBool::True,
4143 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::BoolTy)),
4144 CS.getInstruction());
4145
4146 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
4147 CS.getInstruction()->
4148 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
4149
4150 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
4151 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
4152 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
4153 ConstantBool::True, II);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004154 }
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004155 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
4156 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004157
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00004158 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
4159 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
4160 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
4161 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
4162 // the call.
4163 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
4164 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
4165 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
4166 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
4167 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
4168 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
4169 if (CI->getType()->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(Op->getType())) {
4170 *I = Op;
4171 Changed = true;
4172 }
4173 }
4174 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004175
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00004176 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00004177}
4178
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004179// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
4180// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
4181//
4182bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
4183 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
4184 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Chris Lattnerf3edc492004-07-18 18:59:44 +00004185 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::Cast || !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004186 return false;
Reid Spencer87436872004-07-18 00:38:32 +00004187 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004188 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
4189
4190 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
4191 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
4192 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
4193 //
4194 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
4195 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
4196
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00004197 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
4198 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
4199 if (Callee->isExternal() &&
4200 !OldRetTy->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(FT->getReturnType()) &&
4201 !Caller->use_empty())
4202 return false; // Cannot transform this return value...
4203
4204 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
4205 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
4206 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
4207 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
4208 if (!Caller->use_empty())
4209 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
4210 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
4211 UI != E; ++UI)
4212 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
4213 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00004214 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00004215 return false;
4216 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004217
4218 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
4219 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004220
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004221 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
4222 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
4223 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
4224 bool isConvertible = (*AI)->getType()->isLosslesslyConvertibleTo(ParamTy);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004225 if (Callee->isExternal() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004226 }
4227
4228 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
4229 Callee->isExternal())
4230 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
4231
4232 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
4233 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
4234 std::vector<Value*> Args;
4235 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
4236
4237 AI = CS.arg_begin();
4238 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
4239 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
4240 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
4241 Args.push_back(*AI);
4242 } else {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00004243 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(*AI, ParamTy, "tmp"),
4244 *Caller));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004245 }
4246 }
4247
4248 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
4249 // now...
4250 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
4251 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
4252
4253 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
4254 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
4255 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
4256 std::cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
4257 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
4258 } else {
4259 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
4260 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
4261 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
4262 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
4263 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
4264 Instruction *Cast = new CastInst(*AI, PTy, "tmp");
4265 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
4266 Args.push_back(Cast);
4267 } else {
4268 Args.push_back(*AI);
4269 }
4270 }
4271 }
4272
4273 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
4274 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name...
4275
4276 Instruction *NC;
4277 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00004278 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004279 Args, Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00004280 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004281 } else {
4282 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args, Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner6aacb0f2005-05-06 06:48:21 +00004283 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
4284 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00004285 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004286 }
4287
4288 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary...
4289 Value *NV = NC;
4290 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
4291 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
4292 NV = NC = new CastInst(NC, Caller->getType(), "tmp");
Chris Lattner686767f2003-10-30 00:46:41 +00004293
4294 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
4295 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
4296 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
4297 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
4298 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
4299 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
4300 } else {
4301 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
4302 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
4303 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00004304 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004305 } else {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00004306 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00004307 }
4308 }
4309
4310 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
4311 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
4312 Caller->getParent()->getInstList().erase(Caller);
4313 removeFromWorkList(Caller);
4314 return true;
4315}
4316
4317
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004318// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
4319// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
4320// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
4321Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
4322 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
4323
4324 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
4325 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
4326 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
4327 // code size and simplifying code.
4328 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
4329 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
4330 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
4331 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
4332 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<ShiftInst>(FirstInst)) {
4333 // Can fold binop or shift if the RHS is a constant.
4334 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
4335 if (ConstantOp == 0) return 0;
4336 } else {
4337 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
4338 }
4339
4340 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
4341 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
4342 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
4343 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
4344 if (!I->hasOneUse() || I->getOpcode() != FirstInst->getOpcode())
4345 return 0;
4346 if (CastSrcTy) {
4347 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
4348 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
4349 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
4350 return 0;
4351 }
4352 }
4353
4354 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
4355 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
4356 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
4357 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00004358 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00004359
4360 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
4361 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004362
4363 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00004364 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
4365 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
4366 if (NewInVal != InVal)
4367 InVal = 0;
4368 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
4369 }
4370
4371 Value *PhiVal;
4372 if (InVal) {
4373 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
4374 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
4375 PhiVal = InVal;
4376 delete NewPN;
4377 } else {
4378 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
4379 PhiVal = NewPN;
4380 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004381
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004382 // Insert and return the new operation.
4383 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00004384 return new CastInst(PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004385 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00004386 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004387 else
4388 return new ShiftInst(cast<ShiftInst>(FirstInst)->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00004389 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004390}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00004391
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00004392/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
4393/// that is dead.
4394static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN, std::set<PHINode*> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
4395 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
4396 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
4397
4398 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
4399 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN).second)
4400 return true;
4401
4402 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
4403 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004404
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00004405 return false;
4406}
4407
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00004408// PHINode simplification
4409//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004410Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00004411 if (Value *V = hasConstantValue(&PN)) {
4412 // If V is an instruction, we have to be certain that it dominates PN.
4413 // However, because we don't have dom info, we can't do a perfect job.
4414 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4415 // We know that the instruction dominates the PHI if there are no undef
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00004416 // values coming in. If the instruction is defined in the entry block,
4417 // and is not an invoke, we know it is ok.
Chris Lattner3b92f172004-10-18 01:48:31 +00004418 if (I->getParent() != &I->getParent()->getParent()->front() ||
4419 isa<InvokeInst>(I))
Chris Lattner107c15c2004-10-17 21:31:34 +00004420 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
4421 if (isa<UndefValue>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) {
4422 V = 0;
4423 break;
4424 }
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00004425 }
4426
4427 if (V)
4428 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
4429 }
Chris Lattner4db2d222004-02-16 05:07:08 +00004430
4431 // If the only user of this instruction is a cast instruction, and all of the
4432 // incoming values are constants, change this PHI to merge together the casted
4433 // constants.
4434 if (PN.hasOneUse())
4435 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(PN.use_back()))
4436 if (CI->getType() != PN.getType()) { // noop casts will be folded
4437 bool AllConstant = true;
4438 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
4439 if (!isa<Constant>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) {
4440 AllConstant = false;
4441 break;
4442 }
4443 if (AllConstant) {
4444 // Make a new PHI with all casted values.
4445 PHINode *New = new PHINode(CI->getType(), PN.getName(), &PN);
4446 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
4447 Constant *OldArg = cast<Constant>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
4448 New->addIncoming(ConstantExpr::getCast(OldArg, New->getType()),
4449 PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
4450 }
4451
4452 // Update the cast instruction.
4453 CI->setOperand(0, New);
4454 WorkList.push_back(CI); // revisit the cast instruction to fold.
4455 WorkList.push_back(New); // Make sure to revisit the new Phi
4456 return &PN; // PN is now dead!
4457 }
4458 }
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00004459
4460 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
4461 // reducing code size.
4462 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
4463 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
4464 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
4465 return Result;
4466
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00004467 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
4468 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
4469 // PHI)... break the cycle.
4470 if (PN.hasOneUse())
4471 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN.use_back())) {
4472 std::set<PHINode*> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
4473 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
4474 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
4475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
4476 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004477
Chris Lattner91daeb52003-12-19 05:58:40 +00004478 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00004479}
4480
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004481static Value *InsertSignExtendToPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
4482 Instruction *InsertPoint,
4483 InstCombiner *IC) {
4484 unsigned PS = IC->getTargetData().getPointerSize();
4485 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004486 if (!VTy->isSigned() && VTy->getPrimitiveSize() < PS)
4487 // We must insert a cast to ensure we sign-extend.
4488 V = IC->InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(V, VTy->getSignedVersion(),
4489 V->getName()), *InsertPoint);
4490 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(V, DTy, V->getName()),
4491 *InsertPoint);
4492}
4493
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00004494
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004495Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004496 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner471bd762003-05-22 19:07:21 +00004497 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, long 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004498 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00004499 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004500 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00004501
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004502 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
4503 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
4504
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00004505 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
4506 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
4507 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
4508
4509 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00004511
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004512 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
4513 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004514 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4515 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI)
4516 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
4517 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
4518 Value *Src = CI->getOperand(0);
4519 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
4520 const Type *DestTy = CI->getType();
4521 if (Src->getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004522 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
4523 DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004524 // We can always eliminate a cast from ulong or long to the other.
4525 // We can always eliminate a cast from uint to int or the other on
4526 // 32-bit pointer platforms.
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004527 if (DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()){
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004528 MadeChange = true;
4529 GEP.setOperand(i, Src);
4530 }
4531 } else if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSize() < DestTy->getPrimitiveSize() &&
4532 SrcTy->getPrimitiveSize() == 4) {
4533 // We can always eliminate a cast from int to [u]long. We can
4534 // eliminate a cast from uint to [u]long iff the target is a 32-bit
4535 // pointer target.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004536 if (SrcTy->isSigned() ||
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004537 SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004538 MadeChange = true;
4539 GEP.setOperand(i, Src);
4540 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004541 }
4542 }
4543 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004544 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
4545 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
4546 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
4547 // obvious.
4548 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
4549 if (Op->getType()->getPrimitiveSize() > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00004550 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner44d0b952004-07-20 01:48:15 +00004551 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getCast(C,
4552 TD->getIntPtrType()->getSignedVersion()));
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00004553 MadeChange = true;
4554 } else {
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00004555 Op = InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
4556 Op->getName()), GEP);
4557 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
4558 MadeChange = true;
4559 }
Chris Lattner44d0b952004-07-20 01:48:15 +00004560
4561 // If this is a constant idx, make sure to canonicalize it to be a signed
4562 // operand, otherwise CSE and other optimizations are pessimized.
4563 if (ConstantUInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(Op)) {
4564 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getCast(CUI,
4565 CUI->getType()->getSignedVersion()));
4566 MadeChange = true;
4567 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004568 }
4569 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
4570
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00004571 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
4572 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
4573 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
4574 //
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00004575 std::vector<Value*> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004576 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00004577 SrcGEPOperands.assign(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00004578
4579 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004580 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
4581 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
4582 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
4583 //
4584 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
4585 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
4586 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
4587
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00004588 std::vector<Value *> Indices;
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004589
4590 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
4591 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
4592 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
4593 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattner8ec5f882004-05-08 22:41:42 +00004594 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004595
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00004596 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004597 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattner235af562003-03-05 22:33:14 +00004598 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
4599 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
4600 //
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004601 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004602 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
4603 Sum = GO1;
4604 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
4605 Sum = SO1;
4606 } else {
4607 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
4608 // target's pointer size.
4609 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
4610 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
4611 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getCast(SO1C, GO1->getType());
4612 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
4613 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getCast(GO1C, SO1->getType());
4614 } else {
4615 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004616 if (SO1->getType()->getPrimitiveSize() == PS) {
4617 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
4618 GO1 = InsertSignExtendToPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
4619
4620 } else if (GO1->getType()->getPrimitiveSize() == PS) {
4621 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
4622 SO1 = InsertSignExtendToPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
4623 } else {
4624 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
4625 SO1 = InsertSignExtendToPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
4626 GO1 = InsertSignExtendToPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
4627 }
4628 }
4629 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004630 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
4631 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
4632 else {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004633 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
4634 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004635 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004636 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004637
4638 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
4639 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
4640 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
4641 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
4642 return &GEP;
4643 } else {
4644 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
4645 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
4646 Indices.push_back(Sum);
4647 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
4648 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004649 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004650 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004651 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00004652 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00004653 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
4654 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00004655 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
4656 }
4657
4658 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00004659 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices, GEP.getName());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00004660
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004661 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00004662 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
4663 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
4664
4665 // Scan for nonconstants...
4666 std::vector<Constant*> Indices;
4667 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
4668 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
4669 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
4670
4671 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattnerf3edc492004-07-18 18:59:44 +00004672 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV, Indices);
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00004673
4674 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
4675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
4676 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00004677 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00004678 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::Cast) {
4679 if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
4680 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
4681 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
4682 //
4683 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
4684 //
4685 Constant *X = CE->getOperand(0);
4686 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType());
4687 if (const PointerType *XTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(X->getType()))
4688 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
4689 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
4690 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
4691 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
4692 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
4693 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
4694 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
4695 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
4696 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
4697 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
4698 return &GEP;
4699 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004700 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 &&
4701 isa<PointerType>(CE->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Chris Lattner14f3cdc2004-11-27 17:55:46 +00004702 // Transform things like:
4703 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x sbyte]* %str to ubyte*), uint %V
4704 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x sbyte*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
4705 Constant *X = CE->getOperand(0);
4706 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
4707 const Type *ResElTy =cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
4708 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004709 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
Chris Lattner14f3cdc2004-11-27 17:55:46 +00004710 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
4711 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
4712 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::IntTy),
4713 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
4714 return new CastInst(V, GEP.getType());
4715 }
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00004716 }
4717 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00004718 }
4719
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00004720 return 0;
4721}
4722
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004723Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
4724 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
4725 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
4726 if (const ConstantUInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantUInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
4727 const Type *NewTy = ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getValue());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00004728 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004729
4730 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
4731 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004732 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00004733 else {
4734 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004735 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00004736 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004737
4738 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004739
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004740 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
4741 // allocas if possible...
4742 //
4743 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
4744 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
4745
4746 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
4747 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
4748 //
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00004749 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::IntTy);
4750 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
4751 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004752
4753 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
4754 // allocation.
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004756 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
4757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004758 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004759
4760 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
4761 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
4762 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004763 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattner49df6ce2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00004764 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00004765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
4766
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00004767 return 0;
4768}
4769
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00004770Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
4771 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
4772
4773 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
4774 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
4775 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
4776 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
4777 return &FI;
4778 }
4779
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004780 // free undef -> unreachable.
4781 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
4782 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
4783 new StoreInst(ConstantBool::True,
4784 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::BoolTy)), &FI);
4785 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
4786 }
4787
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00004788 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
4789 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004790 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00004791 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00004792
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00004793 return 0;
4794}
4795
4796
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004797/// GetGEPGlobalInitializer - Given a constant, and a getelementptr
4798/// constantexpr, return the constant value being addressed by the constant
4799/// expression, or null if something is funny.
4800///
4801static Constant *GetGEPGlobalInitializer(Constant *C, ConstantExpr *CE) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00004802 if (CE->getOperand(1) != Constant::getNullValue(CE->getOperand(1)->getType()))
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004803 return 0; // Do not allow stepping over the value!
4804
4805 // Loop over all of the operands, tracking down which value we are
4806 // addressing...
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004807 gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(CE), E = gep_type_end(CE);
4808 for (++I; I != E; ++I)
4809 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*I)) {
4810 ConstantUInt *CU = cast<ConstantUInt>(I.getOperand());
4811 assert(CU->getValue() < STy->getNumElements() &&
4812 "Struct index out of range!");
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00004813 unsigned El = (unsigned)CU->getValue();
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004814 if (ConstantStruct *CS = dyn_cast<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00004815 C = CS->getOperand(El);
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004816 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C)) {
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004817 C = Constant::getNullValue(STy->getElementType(El));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004818 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) {
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004819 C = UndefValue::get(STy->getElementType(El));
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004820 } else {
4821 return 0;
4822 }
4823 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand())) {
4824 const ArrayType *ATy = cast<ArrayType>(*I);
4825 if ((uint64_t)CI->getRawValue() >= ATy->getNumElements()) return 0;
4826 if (ConstantArray *CA = dyn_cast<ConstantArray>(C))
Chris Lattnerfdfe3e492005-01-08 19:42:22 +00004827 C = CA->getOperand((unsigned)CI->getRawValue());
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004828 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
4829 C = Constant::getNullValue(ATy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004830 else if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
4831 C = UndefValue::get(ATy->getElementType());
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004832 else
4833 return 0;
4834 } else {
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004835 return 0;
Chris Lattnered79d8a2004-05-27 17:30:27 +00004836 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004837 return C;
4838}
4839
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00004840/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00004841static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
4842 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00004843 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00004844
4845 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00004846 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00004847 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00004848
4849 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
4850 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
4851 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
4852 // constants.
4853 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
4854 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
4855 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
4856 std::vector<Value*> Idxs(2, Constant::getNullValue(Type::IntTy));
4857 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs);
4858 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
4859 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
4860 }
4861
4862 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerecfa9b52005-03-29 06:37:47 +00004863 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
4864 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
4865 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004866 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSize(SrcPTy) ==
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00004867 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSize(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004868
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00004869 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
4870 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
4871 // the result of the loaded value.
4872 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
4873 CI->getName(),
4874 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
4875 // Now cast the result of the load.
4876 return new CastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
4877 }
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00004878 }
4879 }
4880 return 0;
4881}
4882
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004883/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00004884/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
4885/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
4886/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
4887static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
4888 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
4889 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
4890
4891 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
4892 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00004893 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
4894 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
4895 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00004896 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
4897
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00004898 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00004899 --BBI;
4900
4901 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
4902 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
4903 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
4904 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004905
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00004906 }
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00004907 return false;
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004908}
4909
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004910Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
4911 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7e8af382004-01-12 04:13:56 +00004912
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00004913 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
4914 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
4915 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
4916 return Res;
4917
4918 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
4919 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
4920
4921 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
4922 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0)) ||
4923 isa<UndefValue>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
4924 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
4925 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
4926 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
4927 // CFG.
4928 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
4929 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
4930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
4931 }
4932
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004933 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00004934 // load null/undef -> undef
4935 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004936 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
4937 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
4938 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00004939 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
4940 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004941 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00004942 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00004943
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004944 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
4945 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
4946 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isExternal())
4947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004948
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004949 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
4950 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
4951 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
4952 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
4953 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isExternal())
4954 if (Constant *V = GetGEPGlobalInitializer(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
4955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00004956 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
4957 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
4958 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
4959 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
4960 // CFG.
4961 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
4962 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
4963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
4964 }
4965
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004966 } else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::Cast) {
4967 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
4968 return Res;
4969 }
4970 }
Chris Lattnere228ee52004-04-08 20:39:49 +00004971
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00004972 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004973 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
4974 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
4975 // exposes redundancy in the code.
4976 //
4977 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
4978 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
4979 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
4980 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
4981 // unconditionally.
4982 //
4983 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
4984 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00004985 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
4986 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004987 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00004988 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004989 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00004990 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00004991 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
4992 }
4993
Chris Lattnerbdcf41a2004-09-23 15:46:00 +00004994 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
4995 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
4996 if (C->isNullValue()) {
4997 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
4998 return &LI;
4999 }
5000
5001 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
5002 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
5003 if (C->isNullValue()) {
5004 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
5005 return &LI;
5006 }
5007
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00005008 } else if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
5009 // load (phi (&V1, &V2, &V3)) --> phi(load &V1, load &V2, load &V3)
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00005010 bool Safe = PN->getParent() == LI.getParent();
5011
5012 // Scan all of the instructions between the PHI and the load to make
5013 // sure there are no instructions that might possibly alter the value
5014 // loaded from the PHI.
5015 if (Safe) {
5016 BasicBlock::iterator I = &LI;
5017 for (--I; !isa<PHINode>(I); --I)
5018 if (isa<StoreInst>(I) || isa<CallInst>(I)) {
5019 Safe = false;
5020 break;
5021 }
5022 }
5023
5024 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e && Safe; ++i)
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00005025 if (!isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00005026 PN->getIncomingBlock(i)->getTerminator()))
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00005027 Safe = false;
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00005028
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00005029 if (Safe) {
5030 // Create the PHI.
5031 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(LI.getType(), PN->getName());
5032 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
5033 std::map<BasicBlock*,Value*> LoadMap; // Don't insert duplicate loads
5034
5035 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
5036 BasicBlock *BB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
5037 Value *&TheLoad = LoadMap[BB];
5038 if (TheLoad == 0) {
5039 Value *InVal = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
5040 TheLoad = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(InVal,
5041 InVal->getName()+".val"),
5042 *BB->getTerminator());
5043 }
5044 NewPN->addIncoming(TheLoad, BB);
5045 }
5046 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NewPN);
5047 }
5048 }
5049 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00005050 return 0;
5051}
5052
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00005053/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold 'store V, (cast P)' -> store (cast V), P'
5054/// when possible.
5055static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
5056 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
5057 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
5058
5059 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
5060 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
5061 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
5062
5063 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
5064 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
5065 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
5066 // constants.
5067 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
5068 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
5069 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
5070 std::vector<Value*> Idxs(2, Constant::getNullValue(Type::IntTy));
5071 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs);
5072 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
5073 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
5074 }
5075
5076 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005077 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSize(SrcPTy) ==
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00005078 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSize(DestPTy)) {
5079
5080 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
5081 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the store, cast
5082 // the value to be stored.
5083 Value *NewCast;
5084 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(0)))
5085 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(C, SrcPTy);
5086 else
5087 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new CastInst(SI.getOperand(0),
5088 SrcPTy,
5089 SI.getOperand(0)->getName()+".c"), SI);
5090
5091 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
5092 }
5093 }
5094 }
5095 return 0;
5096}
5097
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00005098Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
5099 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
5100 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
5101
5102 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
5103 removeFromWorkList(&SI);
5104 SI.eraseFromParent();
5105 ++NumCombined;
5106 return 0;
5107 }
5108
5109 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile loads.
5110
5111 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
5112 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
5113 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
5114 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
5115 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
5116 WorkList.push_back(U); // Dropped a use.
5117 ++NumCombined;
5118 }
5119 return 0; // Do not modify these!
5120 }
5121
5122 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
5123 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
5124 removeFromWorkList(&SI);
5125 SI.eraseFromParent();
5126 ++NumCombined;
5127 return 0;
5128 }
5129
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00005130 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
5131 // source instead.
5132 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Ptr))
5133 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
5134 return Res;
5135 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
5136 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::Cast)
5137 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
5138 return Res;
5139
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00005140 return 0;
5141}
5142
5143
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00005144Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
5145 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00005146 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005147 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
5148 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
5149 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
5150 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
5151 // Swap Destinations and condition...
5152 BI.setCondition(X);
5153 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
5154 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
5155 return &BI;
5156 }
5157
5158 // Cannonicalize setne -> seteq
5159 Instruction::BinaryOps Op; Value *Y;
5160 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_SetCond(Op, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
5161 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
5162 if ((Op == Instruction::SetNE || Op == Instruction::SetLE ||
5163 Op == Instruction::SetGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
5164 SetCondInst *I = cast<SetCondInst>(BI.getCondition());
5165 std::string Name = I->getName(); I->setName("");
5166 Instruction::BinaryOps NewOpcode = SetCondInst::getInverseCondition(Op);
5167 Value *NewSCC = BinaryOperator::create(NewOpcode, X, Y, Name, I);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005168 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005169 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005170 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
5171 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00005172 removeFromWorkList(I);
5173 I->getParent()->getInstList().erase(I);
5174 WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(NewSCC));
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005175 return &BI;
5176 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005177
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00005178 return 0;
5179}
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00005180
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00005181Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
5182 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
5183 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
5184 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
5185 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
5186 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
5187 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005188 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00005189 AddRHS));
5190 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
5191 WorkList.push_back(I);
5192 return &SI;
5193 }
5194 }
5195 return 0;
5196}
5197
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00005198
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005199void InstCombiner::removeFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
5200 WorkList.erase(std::remove(WorkList.begin(), WorkList.end(), I),
5201 WorkList.end());
5202}
5203
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00005204
5205/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
5206/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
5207/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
5208/// end of its block.
5209static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
5210 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
5211
5212 // Cannot move control-flow-involving instructions.
5213 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || isa<InvokeInst>(I) || isa<CallInst>(I)) return false;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005214
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00005215 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
5216 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() == &DestBlock->getParent()->front())
5217 return false;
5218
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00005219 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
5220 // the end of block that could change the value.
5221 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
5222 if (LI->isVolatile()) return false; // Don't sink volatile loads.
5223
5224 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
5225 Scan != E; ++Scan)
5226 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
5227 return false;
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00005228 }
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00005229
5230 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
5231 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
5232
5233 BasicBlock *SrcBlock = I->getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005234 DestBlock->getInstList().splice(InsertPos, SrcBlock->getInstList(), I);
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00005235 ++NumSunkInst;
5236 return true;
5237}
5238
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005239bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00005240 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00005241 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00005242
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00005243 {
5244 // Populate the worklist with the reachable instructions.
5245 std::set<BasicBlock*> Visited;
5246 for (df_ext_iterator<BasicBlock*> BB = df_ext_begin(&F.front(), Visited),
5247 E = df_ext_end(&F.front(), Visited); BB != E; ++BB)
5248 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); I != E; ++I)
5249 WorkList.push_back(I);
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005250
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00005251 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
5252 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
5253 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
5254 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
5255 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
5256 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
5257 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
5258 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner2d3a7a62004-04-27 15:13:33 +00005259
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00005260 DEBUG(std::cerr << "IC: DCE: " << *I);
5261 ++NumDeadInst;
5262
5263 if (!I->use_empty())
5264 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
5265 I->eraseFromParent();
5266 }
5267 }
5268 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00005269
5270 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
5271 Instruction *I = WorkList.back(); // Get an instruction from the worklist
5272 WorkList.pop_back();
5273
Misha Brukman632df282002-10-29 23:06:16 +00005274 // Check to see if we can DCE or ConstantPropagate the instruction...
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005275 // Check to see if we can DIE the instruction...
5276 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
5277 // Add operands to the worklist...
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005278 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00005279 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005280 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005281
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00005282 DEBUG(std::cerr << "IC: DCE: " << *I);
5283
5284 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005285 removeFromWorkList(I);
5286 continue;
5287 }
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005288
Misha Brukman632df282002-10-29 23:06:16 +00005289 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it...
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005290 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I)) {
Alkis Evlogimenosa1291a02004-12-08 23:10:30 +00005291 Value* Ptr = I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner6580e092004-10-16 19:44:59 +00005292 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(I) &&
Alkis Evlogimenosa1291a02004-12-08 23:10:30 +00005293 cast<Constant>(Ptr)->isNullValue() &&
5294 !isa<ConstantPointerNull>(C) &&
5295 cast<PointerType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementType()->isSized()) {
Chris Lattner6580e092004-10-16 19:44:59 +00005296 // If this is a constant expr gep that is effectively computing an
5297 // "offsetof", fold it into 'cast int X to T*' instead of 'gep 0, 0, 12'
5298 bool isFoldableGEP = true;
5299 for (unsigned i = 1, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5300 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(i)))
5301 isFoldableGEP = false;
5302 if (isFoldableGEP) {
Alkis Evlogimenosa1291a02004-12-08 23:10:30 +00005303 uint64_t Offset = TD->getIndexedOffset(Ptr->getType(),
Chris Lattner6580e092004-10-16 19:44:59 +00005304 std::vector<Value*>(I->op_begin()+1, I->op_end()));
5305 C = ConstantUInt::get(Type::ULongTy, Offset);
Chris Lattner684c5c62004-10-16 19:46:33 +00005306 C = ConstantExpr::getCast(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner6580e092004-10-16 19:44:59 +00005307 C = ConstantExpr::getCast(C, I->getType());
5308 }
5309 }
5310
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00005311 DEBUG(std::cerr << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I);
5312
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005313 // Add operands to the worklist...
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00005314 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc6509f42002-12-05 22:41:53 +00005315 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
5316
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005317 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005318 I->getParent()->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner800aaaf2003-10-07 15:17:02 +00005319 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005320 continue;
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005321 }
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005322
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00005323 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
5324 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
5325 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
5326 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
5327 if (UserParent != BB) {
5328 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
5329 // See if the user is one of our successors.
5330 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
5331 if (*SI == UserParent) {
5332 UserIsSuccessor = true;
5333 break;
5334 }
5335
5336 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
5337 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
5338 // otherwise), we can keep going.
5339 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
5340 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
5341 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
5342 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
5343 }
5344 }
5345
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00005346 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00005347 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner0b18c1d2002-05-10 15:38:35 +00005348 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00005349 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00005350 if (Result != I) {
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00005351 DEBUG(std::cerr << "IC: Old = " << *I
5352 << " New = " << *Result);
5353
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00005354 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
5355 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
5356
5357 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
5358 WorkList.push_back(Result);
5359 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005360
5361 // Move the name to the new instruction first...
5362 std::string OldName = I->getName(); I->setName("");
Chris Lattner950fc782003-10-07 22:58:41 +00005363 Result->setName(OldName);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005364
5365 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
5366 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00005367 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
5368
5369 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
5370 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
5371 ++InsertPos;
5372
5373 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005374
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00005375 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
5376 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerb643a9e2004-05-01 23:19:52 +00005377 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5378 if (Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i)))
5379 WorkList.push_back(OpI);
5380
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00005381 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
5382 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
5383 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00005384
5385 // Erase the old instruction.
5386 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005387 } else {
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00005388 DEBUG(std::cerr << "IC: MOD = " << *I);
5389
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00005390 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
5391 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00005392 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
5393 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
5394 // use counts.
5395 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5396 if (Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i)))
5397 WorkList.push_back(OpI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005398
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00005399 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
5400 // occurrances of this instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00005401 removeFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00005402 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00005403 } else {
5404 WorkList.push_back(Result);
5405 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00005406 }
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00005407 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00005408 Changed = true;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00005409 }
5410 }
5411
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00005412 return Changed;
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00005413}
5414
Brian Gaeke38b79e82004-07-27 17:43:21 +00005415FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00005416 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00005417}
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +00005418